6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
16 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
17 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
18 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
19 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
20 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
21 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
22 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
23 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari@*
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Ricardo Wurmus@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Chris Marusich@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Efraim Flashner@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 ng0@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele
34 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
35 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
36 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
37 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
38 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
39 Documentation License''.
42 @dircategory System administration
44 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
45 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
46 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
47 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
48 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
49 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
52 @dircategory Software development
54 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
59 * Guix user interface: (guix)Emacs Interface. Package management from the comfort of Emacs.
64 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
65 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
66 @author The GNU Guix Developers
69 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
70 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
78 @c *********************************************************************
82 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
83 package management tool written for the GNU system.
86 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
87 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
88 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
89 * Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
90 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
91 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
92 * GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
93 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
95 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
96 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
97 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
98 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
101 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
105 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
106 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
107 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
108 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
109 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
110 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
112 Setting Up the Daemon
114 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
115 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
119 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
120 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
121 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
122 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
123 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
124 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
125 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
129 * Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
130 * Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
131 * Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
132 * Package Source Locations: Emacs Package Locations. Interface for package location files.
133 * Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
134 * Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
135 * Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
136 * Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
137 * Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
138 * Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
140 Programming Interface
142 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
143 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
144 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
145 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
146 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
147 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
151 * package Reference:: The package data type.
152 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
156 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
157 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
158 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
159 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
160 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
161 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
162 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
163 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
164 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
165 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
166 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
167 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
168 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
170 Invoking @command{guix build}
172 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
173 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
174 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
178 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
179 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
180 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
181 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
182 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
183 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
184 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
185 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
189 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
190 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
191 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
192 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
193 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
194 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
195 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
199 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
200 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
201 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
202 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
203 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
204 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
205 * Services:: Specifying system services.
206 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
207 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
208 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
209 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
210 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
211 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
212 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
213 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
217 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
218 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
219 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
220 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
221 * X Window:: Graphical display.
222 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
223 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
224 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
225 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
226 * Web Services:: Web servers.
227 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
228 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
232 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
233 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
234 * Service Reference:: API reference.
235 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
239 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
240 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
241 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
242 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
243 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
244 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
245 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
246 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
250 * Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
251 * Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
252 * The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
253 * Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
254 * Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
258 * Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
259 * Modules:: Where to store your code?
260 * Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
261 * Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
266 @c *********************************************************************
268 @chapter Introduction
271 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
272 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
273 management tool for the GNU system. Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
274 users to install, upgrade, or remove packages, to roll back to a
275 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
276 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
278 @cindex user interfaces
279 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
280 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}), a set of command-line utilities
281 (@pxref{Utilities}), a visual user interface in Emacs (@pxref{Emacs
282 Interface}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
283 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
285 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
286 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
287 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
289 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
290 @cindex customization, of packages
291 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
292 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
293 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
294 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
295 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
296 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
297 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
298 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
300 @cindex Guix System Distribution
302 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system
303 where it complements the available tools without interference
304 (@pxref{Installation}), or you can use it as part of the standalone
305 @dfn{Guix System Distribution} or GuixSD (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
306 With GNU@tie{}GuixSD, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating
307 system configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the
308 configuration in a transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion
309 (@pxref{System Configuration}).
311 @cindex functional package management
312 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
313 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
314 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
315 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
316 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
317 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
318 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
319 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
320 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
321 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
322 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
323 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
324 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
325 explicit inputs are visible.
328 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
329 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
330 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
331 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
332 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
333 input yields a different directory name.
335 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
336 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
337 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
340 @c *********************************************************************
342 @chapter Installation
344 @cindex installing Guix
345 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
346 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
347 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
350 Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
351 manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
352 instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
353 @pxref{System Installation}.
355 @cindex foreign distro
356 When installed on a running GNU/Linux system---thereafter called a
357 @dfn{foreign distro}---GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available tools
358 without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
359 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your
360 system, such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
363 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
364 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
365 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
366 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
367 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
368 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
371 @node Binary Installation
372 @section Binary Installation
374 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
375 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
376 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
377 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
378 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
381 Installing goes along these lines:
385 @cindex downloading Guix binary
386 Download the binary tarball from
387 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
388 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
389 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
391 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
392 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
393 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
396 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
397 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
400 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
401 then run this command to import it:
404 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
408 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
409 @c end authentication part
416 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
417 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
418 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
421 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
422 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
425 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
426 would overwrite its own essential files.
428 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
429 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
430 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
432 They stem from the fact that all the
433 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
434 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
435 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
439 Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
442 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
447 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
448 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
451 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
453 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
457 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
459 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
462 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
465 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf /etc/init/
469 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
472 # ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
476 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
480 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
482 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
485 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
489 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
490 # cd /usr/local/share/info
491 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
495 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
496 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
497 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
501 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
502 To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or one of its mirrors
503 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
506 # guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
510 This completes root-level install of Guix. Each user will need to
511 perform additional steps to make their Guix environment ready for use,
512 @pxref{Application Setup}.
514 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
518 # guix package -i hello
521 The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s profile,
522 or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which case you
523 would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the @command{guix}
524 command. In other words, do not remove @code{guix} by running
525 @code{guix package -r guix}.
527 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
528 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
531 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
536 @section Requirements
538 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
539 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
540 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
541 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
543 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
546 @item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
547 @item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
548 @item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
551 The following dependencies are optional:
555 Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will allow you to
556 access @code{https} URLs for substitutes, which is highly recommended
557 (@pxref{Substitutes}). It also allows you to access HTTPS URLs with the
558 @command{guix download} command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the
559 @command{guix import pypi} command, and the @command{guix import cpan}
560 command. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings
561 for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
565 @url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
566 allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
567 guix import}). It is of
568 interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
571 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
572 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) depends on
573 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
574 version 0.10.2 or later.
577 When @url{http://zlib.net, zlib} is available, @command{guix publish}
578 can compress build byproducts (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
581 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
582 following packages are also needed:
585 @item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
586 @item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
587 @item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
591 @cindex state directory
592 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
593 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
594 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
595 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
596 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
597 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
598 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
600 @cindex Nix, compatibility
601 When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
602 manager} is available, you
603 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
604 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
606 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
607 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
608 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
609 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
610 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
611 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
612 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
613 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
614 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
616 @node Running the Test Suite
617 @section Running the Test Suite
620 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
621 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
622 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
623 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
630 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
631 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
632 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
633 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
636 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
637 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
640 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
643 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
644 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
645 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
648 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
651 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
652 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
653 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
656 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
657 GuixSD operating system instances. It can only run on systems where
658 Guix is already installed, using:
665 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
668 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
671 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
672 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
673 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
674 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
675 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
676 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
678 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
681 @node Setting Up the Daemon
682 @section Setting Up the Daemon
685 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
686 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
687 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
688 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
689 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
690 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
691 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
693 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
694 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
695 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
698 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
699 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
702 @node Build Environment Setup
703 @subsection Build Environment Setup
705 @cindex build environment
706 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
707 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
708 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
709 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
710 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
711 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
712 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
715 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
716 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
717 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
718 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
719 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
720 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
721 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
722 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
723 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
724 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
726 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
727 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
729 @c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
730 @c for why `-G' is needed.
732 # groupadd --system guixbuild
733 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
735 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
736 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
737 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
743 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
744 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
745 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
746 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
747 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
748 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
749 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
751 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
752 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
753 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
754 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
755 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
756 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
757 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
758 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
761 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
766 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
767 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
768 environment contains nothing but:
770 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
773 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
774 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
775 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
776 can only be created if the host has them.};
779 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
780 since a separate PID name space is used;
783 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
787 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
790 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
794 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
797 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
798 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
799 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
800 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
801 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
802 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
803 capture the name of their build tree.
806 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
807 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
808 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
810 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
811 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
812 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
813 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
814 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
815 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
816 @emph{pure} functions.
819 @node Daemon Offload Setup
820 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
824 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
825 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
826 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
827 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
829 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
830 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
831 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
832 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
833 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
834 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
835 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
836 build are copied back to the initial machine.
838 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
842 (name "eightysix.example.org")
843 (system "x86_64-linux")
844 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
846 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
849 (name "meeps.example.org")
850 (system "mips64el-linux")
851 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
854 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
855 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
859 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
860 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
863 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
864 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
865 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
866 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
867 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
868 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
869 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
872 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
873 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
874 builds. The important fields are:
879 The host name of the remote machine.
882 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
885 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
886 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
887 allow non-interactive logins.
890 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
891 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
892 long string that looks like this:
895 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
898 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
899 key can be found in a file such as
900 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
902 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
903 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
904 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
905 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
908 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
909 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
914 A number of optional fields may be specified:
918 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
919 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
921 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~/.ssh/id_rsa})
922 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
925 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
926 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
927 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
929 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
930 when transferring files to and from build machines.
932 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
933 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
936 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
937 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
939 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
940 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
941 machines with a higher speed factor.
943 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
944 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
945 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
946 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
947 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
952 The @code{guile} command must be in the search path on the build
953 machines. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
954 @code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
955 this is the case by running:
958 ssh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
961 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
962 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
963 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
964 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
965 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
968 # guix archive --generate-key
972 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
973 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
976 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
980 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
982 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
983 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
984 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
985 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
986 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
989 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
996 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
997 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
998 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
999 from it, and report any error in the process.
1001 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1005 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1008 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1009 regular expression like this:
1012 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1015 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1016 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1018 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1019 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1020 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1021 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1024 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1028 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1031 @cindex container, build environment
1032 @cindex build environment
1033 @cindex reproducible builds
1034 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1035 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1036 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1037 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1038 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1039 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1040 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1041 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1042 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1043 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1044 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1046 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1047 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1048 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
1049 the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
1050 directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
1051 with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
1052 sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
1053 it would otherwise not hit.
1055 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1056 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1057 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1059 The following command-line options are supported:
1062 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1063 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1064 the Daemon, build users}).
1066 @item --no-substitutes
1068 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1069 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1070 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1072 By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
1073 @command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
1074 @code{--no-substitutes}.
1076 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1077 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1078 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1080 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1081 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1082 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1083 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1084 @indicateurl{https://mirror.hydra.gnu.org https://hydra.gnu.org} is used
1085 (@code{mirror.hydra.gnu.org} is a mirror of @code{hydra.gnu.org}).
1087 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1088 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1091 @item --no-build-hook
1092 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1094 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1095 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1096 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1098 @item --cache-failures
1099 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1101 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1102 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1103 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1104 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1106 @item --cores=@var{n}
1108 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1111 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1112 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1115 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1116 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1117 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1119 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1121 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1122 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1123 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1124 Setup}), or simply fail.
1126 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1127 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1128 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1129 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1130 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1132 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1133 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1134 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1137 Produce debugging output.
1139 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1140 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1141 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1143 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1144 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1146 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1147 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1148 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1149 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1152 @item --disable-chroot
1153 Disable chroot builds.
1155 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1156 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1157 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1160 @item --disable-log-compression
1161 Disable compression of the build logs.
1163 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1164 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1165 them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
1167 @item --disable-deduplication
1168 @cindex deduplication
1169 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1171 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1172 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1173 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1174 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1175 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1178 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1179 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1182 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1183 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1184 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
1186 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1187 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1188 corresponding to live outputs.
1190 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1191 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1192 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1193 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1195 Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
1196 @code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
1197 prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
1198 tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
1199 prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
1200 saves rebuilds or downloads.
1202 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1203 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1204 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1206 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1207 on the kernel version number.
1210 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1211 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1213 @item --system=@var{system}
1214 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1215 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1216 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1218 @item --listen=@var{socket}
1219 Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1220 socket. The default socket is
1221 @file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1222 useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1223 daemons on the same machine.
1227 @node Application Setup
1228 @section Application Setup
1230 @cindex foreign distro
1231 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1232 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1233 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1237 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1238 @cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
1240 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1241 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1242 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1243 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1247 $ guix package -i glibc-locales
1248 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1251 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1252 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1253 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1254 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1256 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1257 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1258 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1262 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1263 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1264 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1265 incompatible locale data.
1268 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1269 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1270 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1271 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1272 data in the right format.
1275 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1276 versions may be incompatible.
1278 @subsection Name Service Switch
1280 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1281 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1282 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1283 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1284 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1285 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1286 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1287 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1288 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1289 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1291 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1292 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1293 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1294 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1295 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1297 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1298 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1299 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1300 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1301 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1302 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1303 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1304 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1305 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1308 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1309 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1310 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1311 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1312 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1313 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1314 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1315 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1316 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1318 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1319 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1320 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1321 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1323 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1324 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1325 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1328 @subsection X11 Fonts
1331 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1332 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1333 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1334 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1335 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1336 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1337 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1339 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1340 graphical applications, consider installing
1341 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1342 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1343 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1344 for Chinese languages:
1347 guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1350 @cindex @code{xterm}
1351 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1352 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1353 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1356 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1359 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1360 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1363 xset +fp ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype
1366 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1367 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1368 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1370 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1372 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1373 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1374 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1376 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1377 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1378 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1381 @subsection Emacs Packages
1383 @cindex @code{emacs}
1384 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1385 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1387 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1388 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1389 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1390 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1391 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1392 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1393 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1395 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1396 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1397 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1398 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1399 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1403 @c *********************************************************************
1404 @node Package Management
1405 @chapter Package Management
1408 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
1409 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1410 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1413 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
1414 management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
1415 routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1416 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1417 interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
1420 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
1421 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
1422 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
1423 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
1424 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
1425 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
1426 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
1432 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1433 own directory---something that resembles
1434 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1435 (note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
1436 names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
1438 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1439 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
1440 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1441 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
1443 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
1444 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
1445 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
1446 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1447 simply continues to point to
1448 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
1449 coexist on the same system without any interference.
1451 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1452 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
1453 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
1455 @cindex transactions
1456 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1457 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
1458 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
1459 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
1460 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1461 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1463 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1464 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1465 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
1466 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1467 system configuration on GuixSD is subject to
1468 transactional upgrades and roll-back
1469 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
1471 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1472 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
1473 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
1474 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
1475 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1478 @cindex reproducibility
1479 @cindex reproducible builds
1480 Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1481 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
1482 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
1483 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1484 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1485 given package installation matches the current state of their
1486 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1487 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1488 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1489 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
1492 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
1493 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
1494 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
1495 downloads it and unpacks it;
1496 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1497 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
1498 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
1499 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
1500 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
1502 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1503 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1504 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1505 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
1506 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1508 @node Invoking guix package
1509 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
1511 @cindex installing packages
1512 @cindex removing packages
1513 @cindex package installation
1514 @cindex package removal
1515 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
1516 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1517 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1518 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1522 guix package @var{options}
1524 @cindex transactions
1525 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
1526 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
1527 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
1530 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1531 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1534 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1537 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1538 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1539 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1540 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1543 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
1544 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
1545 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1546 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1547 variable, and so on.
1548 @cindex search paths
1549 If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1550 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1551 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1552 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1555 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1556 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1559 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1560 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1561 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
1562 @code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1563 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
1564 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1565 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1566 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1569 The @var{options} can be among the following:
1573 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1574 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1575 Install the specified @var{package}s.
1577 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
1578 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
1579 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
1580 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1582 If no version number is specified, the
1583 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1584 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
1585 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
1586 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1587 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1588 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
1590 @cindex propagated inputs
1591 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
1592 that automatically get installed along with the required package
1593 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1594 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1595 package definitions).
1597 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
1598 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1599 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1600 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1601 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1602 also been explicitly installed by the user.
1604 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
1605 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
1606 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
1607 environment variable definitions are reported here.
1609 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1611 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1613 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1614 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1615 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1616 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1618 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1619 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1620 multiple-output package.
1622 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1623 @itemx -f @var{file}
1624 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1626 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1627 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1630 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1633 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
1634 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
1635 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1636 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1638 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1639 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1640 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
1642 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
1643 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1644 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1647 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1648 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1649 @cindex upgrading packages
1650 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1651 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
1652 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
1654 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1655 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1656 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1659 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1660 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1661 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1662 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1663 substring ``emacs'':
1666 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1669 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1670 @itemx -m @var{file}
1671 @cindex profile declaration
1672 @cindex profile manifest
1673 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1674 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1676 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1677 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1678 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1679 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1682 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1683 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1686 @findex packages->manifest
1688 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
1693 ;; Use a specific package output.
1694 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1698 @cindex rolling back
1699 @cindex undoing transactions
1700 @cindex transactions, undoing
1701 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1702 the last transaction.
1704 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1705 before any other actions.
1707 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
1708 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1709 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
1711 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
1712 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
1713 generations in a profile is always linear.
1715 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1716 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
1718 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1720 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1721 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1722 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1723 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1724 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1726 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1727 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1728 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1729 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1731 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
1732 @cindex search paths
1733 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1734 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1735 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1736 of the installed packages.
1738 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1739 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1740 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1741 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1742 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1743 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1744 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1746 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1750 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1753 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1754 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1755 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1756 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1758 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1759 of several profiles. Consider this example:
1762 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
1763 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1764 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1767 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1768 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1769 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1772 @item --profile=@var{profile}
1773 @itemx -p @var{profile}
1774 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1777 Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the build log of the
1778 environment on the standard error port.
1781 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1782 useful to distribution developers.
1786 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
1787 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1788 availability of packages:
1792 @item --search=@var{regexp}
1793 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
1794 @cindex searching for packages
1795 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
1796 @var{regexp}. Print all the metadata of matching packages in
1797 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1798 GNU recutils manual}).
1800 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1801 command, for instance:
1804 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
1812 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1813 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1816 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1823 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1824 flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1828 $ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1833 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1834 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1835 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1838 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1839 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1840 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1843 $ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1844 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1848 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1849 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1851 @item --show=@var{package}
1852 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1853 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1857 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1865 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1866 specific version of it:
1868 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
1875 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1876 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
1877 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1878 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1879 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1881 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1882 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1883 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1884 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1887 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1888 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
1889 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
1890 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1891 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1893 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
1894 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1895 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
1897 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1898 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1900 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1901 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
1902 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1905 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1906 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1907 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1908 location of this package in the store.
1910 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1911 generations. Valid patterns include:
1914 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1915 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1918 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1919 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1921 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1922 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
1923 a range must be smaller than its end.
1925 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1926 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1929 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1930 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
1931 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1932 that are up to 20 days old.
1935 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1936 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
1937 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1940 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
1941 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1942 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1943 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1944 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1946 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1947 zeroth generation is never deleted.
1949 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
1950 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1954 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
1955 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
1956 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
1957 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
1958 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
1959 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
1960 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
1961 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
1965 @section Substitutes
1968 @cindex pre-built binaries
1969 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1970 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1971 server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1972 substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1973 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1975 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1976 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1977 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1978 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1980 The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1981 builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
1982 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1983 Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1984 server). This is the
1985 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1986 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1987 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1988 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1989 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1992 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS@footnote{For HTTPS access,
1993 the Guile bindings of GnuTLS must be installed. @xref{Requirements}.}
1994 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
1995 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
1996 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
1997 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
2000 @cindex digital signatures
2001 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
2002 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or a
2004 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
2005 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
2006 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
2007 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
2009 This public key is installed along with Guix, in
2010 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
2011 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
2012 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
2013 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
2014 Then, you can run something like this:
2017 # guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
2020 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
2021 should change from something like:
2024 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
2025 The following derivations would be built:
2026 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
2027 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
2028 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
2029 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
2037 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
2038 The following files would be downloaded:
2039 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
2040 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
2041 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
2042 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
2047 This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
2048 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
2050 Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
2051 one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
2052 when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
2055 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
2056 The @code{http_proxy} environment
2057 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
2058 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
2059 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
2060 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
2061 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
2063 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
2064 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
2065 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
2066 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
2067 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
2068 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
2070 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
2071 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
2072 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
2073 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
2074 build}, and other command-line tools.
2077 @unnumberedsubsec On Trusting Binaries
2079 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
2080 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
2081 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
2082 weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
2083 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
2084 their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
2085 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
2086 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
2087 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
2089 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
2090 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
2091 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
2092 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
2093 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
2094 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
2095 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
2096 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
2097 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
2098 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
2099 @command{guix build --check}}).
2101 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
2102 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
2103 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
2106 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
2107 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
2109 @cindex multiple-output packages
2110 @cindex package outputs
2113 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
2114 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
2115 @command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
2116 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
2117 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
2118 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
2119 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
2122 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
2123 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
2124 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
2125 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
2126 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
2127 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
2128 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
2131 guix package -i glib
2134 @cindex documentation
2135 The command to install its documentation is:
2138 guix package -i glib:doc
2141 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
2142 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
2143 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
2144 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
2145 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
2146 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
2147 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
2148 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
2149 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
2151 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
2152 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
2153 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
2154 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
2155 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
2156 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
2160 @node Invoking guix gc
2161 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
2163 @cindex garbage collector
2165 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
2166 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
2167 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
2168 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
2169 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
2171 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
2172 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
2173 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
2174 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
2175 profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
2176 example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
2178 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
2179 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
2180 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
2181 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
2182 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2184 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
2185 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
2186 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
2187 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
2188 options are as follows:
2191 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
2192 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
2193 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
2194 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
2197 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
2198 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
2199 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
2200 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
2202 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
2204 @item --free-space=@var{free}
2205 @itemx -F @var{free}
2206 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
2207 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
2208 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
2210 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
2211 nothing and exit immediately.
2215 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
2216 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
2217 they are still live.
2219 @item --list-failures
2220 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
2222 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
2223 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2224 @option{--cache-failures}}).
2226 @item --clear-failures
2227 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
2229 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
2230 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
2233 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
2234 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
2237 Show the list of live store files and directories.
2241 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
2247 @cindex package dependencies
2248 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
2254 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
2255 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
2256 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
2257 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
2259 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
2260 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
2261 the graph of references.
2265 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
2266 store and to control disk usage.
2270 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
2271 @cindex integrity, of the store
2272 @cindex integrity checking
2273 Verify the integrity of the store.
2275 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
2276 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
2278 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
2279 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
2281 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
2282 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
2283 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
2284 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
2285 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
2287 @cindex repairing the store
2288 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
2289 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
2290 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
2291 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
2292 system administrator.
2295 @cindex deduplication
2296 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
2297 @dfn{deduplication}.
2299 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
2300 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
2301 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
2302 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
2303 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
2307 @node Invoking guix pull
2308 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
2310 @cindex upgrading Guix
2311 @cindex @command{guix pull}
2313 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
2314 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
2315 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
2316 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
2317 descriptions, and deploys it.
2319 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
2320 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
2321 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
2322 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
2325 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
2326 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
2327 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
2328 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
2329 versa@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates the
2330 @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest Guix,
2331 and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
2333 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
2334 but it supports the following options:
2338 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
2340 @item --url=@var{url}
2341 Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
2343 By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
2344 @code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
2347 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
2348 useful to Guix developers.
2352 @node Invoking guix archive
2353 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2355 @cindex @command{guix archive}
2357 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2358 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2359 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2360 to the store on another machine.
2362 @cindex exporting store items
2363 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
2366 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2369 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2370 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2371 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2372 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2373 output of @code{emacs}:
2376 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
2379 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2380 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
2381 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
2383 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
2387 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
2391 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2392 to another like this:
2395 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2396 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2400 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2401 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2402 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
2403 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2404 items are missing from the target store.
2406 @cindex nar, archive format
2407 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
2408 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
2409 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
2410 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2411 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
2412 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2413 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2414 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2415 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2418 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2419 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2420 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2421 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
2422 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2424 The main options are:
2428 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2429 resulting archive to the standard output.
2431 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2432 @code{--recursive} is passed.
2436 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2437 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2438 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2439 of the exported store items.
2442 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2443 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
2444 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2445 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
2448 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2449 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2452 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
2453 @cindex signing, archives
2454 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
2455 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2456 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2457 generate the key pair.
2459 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2460 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
2461 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2462 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2463 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
2464 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
2465 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2466 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2467 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
2470 @cindex authorizing, archives
2471 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2472 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2473 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2475 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2476 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2477 @url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2478 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2479 @url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2482 @item --extract=@var{directory}
2483 @itemx -x @var{directory}
2484 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2485 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2486 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2488 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2489 served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2493 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2494 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2497 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2498 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2499 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2500 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2503 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2504 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2508 @c *********************************************************************
2511 @c *********************************************************************
2512 @node Programming Interface
2513 @chapter Programming Interface
2515 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2516 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2517 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2518 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2519 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2520 turned into concrete build actions.
2522 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
2523 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
2524 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
2525 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2526 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2529 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2530 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2531 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2532 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2533 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
2534 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2535 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
2537 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2538 package definitions.
2541 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
2542 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
2543 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2544 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2545 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
2546 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
2549 @node Defining Packages
2550 @section Defining Packages
2552 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2553 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2554 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2555 package looks like this:
2558 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
2559 #:use-module (guix packages)
2560 #:use-module (guix download)
2561 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
2562 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2563 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
2565 (define-public hello
2571 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2575 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
2576 (build-system gnu-build-system)
2577 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
2578 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
2579 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2580 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
2581 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
2586 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
2587 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
2588 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
2589 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2590 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2591 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2592 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2594 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2595 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2596 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2598 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
2599 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2600 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2601 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2602 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2604 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2608 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2609 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
2610 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2611 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2613 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2614 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2616 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2617 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2618 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
2619 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
2620 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2621 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
2624 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2625 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2626 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2629 @cindex GNU Build System
2630 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2631 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2632 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2633 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2634 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2637 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2638 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2639 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2640 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
2646 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
2647 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
2648 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
2649 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
2650 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
2651 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
2654 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
2655 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
2656 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
2657 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
2661 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2662 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2663 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2664 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2666 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
2669 @cindex comma (unquote)
2673 @findex unquote-splicing
2674 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
2675 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
2676 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
2677 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
2680 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2681 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
2682 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
2684 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2685 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2686 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2689 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2691 Once a package definition is in place, the
2692 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
2693 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2694 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2695 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2696 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
2697 more information on how to test package definitions, and
2698 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2699 for style conformance.
2701 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
2702 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2703 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
2705 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2706 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
2707 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
2708 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
2709 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2711 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
2712 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2713 (@pxref{Derivations}).
2715 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2716 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2717 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2718 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2719 (@pxref{The Store}).
2723 @cindex cross-compilation
2724 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2725 package for some other system:
2727 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2728 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
2729 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2730 @var{system} to @var{target}.
2732 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2733 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2734 (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2735 Configure and Build System}).
2738 @cindex package transformations
2739 @cindex input rewriting
2740 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
2741 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
2742 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
2743 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
2745 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
2746 [@var{rewrite-name}]
2747 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
2748 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
2749 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
2750 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
2753 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
2754 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
2758 Consider this example:
2761 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
2762 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
2764 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
2766 (define git-with-libressl
2767 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
2771 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
2772 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
2773 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
2774 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
2775 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
2778 * package Reference :: The package data type.
2779 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2783 @node package Reference
2784 @subsection @code{package} Reference
2786 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2787 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2789 @deftp {Data Type} package
2790 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2794 The name of the package, as a string.
2796 @item @code{version}
2797 The version of the package, as a string.
2800 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
2801 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
2802 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
2803 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
2804 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
2805 @code{local-file}}).
2807 @item @code{build-system}
2808 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2811 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2812 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2813 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2815 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2816 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2817 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2818 @cindex inputs, of packages
2819 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2820 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2821 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2822 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2823 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
2824 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
2828 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
2829 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2830 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2833 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2834 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2835 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2836 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2837 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2838 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2840 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
2841 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
2842 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2843 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2845 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2846 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
2847 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
2848 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
2849 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2852 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2853 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2854 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2856 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
2857 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
2858 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
2859 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2860 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2861 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
2863 @item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2864 This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2865 a native input when cross-compiling.
2867 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2868 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2869 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2871 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2872 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2873 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2874 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2876 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
2877 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
2878 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2881 @item @code{synopsis}
2882 A one-line description of the package.
2884 @item @code{description}
2885 A more elaborate description of the package.
2887 @item @code{license}
2888 @cindex license, of packages
2889 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
2890 or a list of such values.
2892 @item @code{home-page}
2893 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2895 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2896 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2897 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2899 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2900 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2902 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
2903 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
2904 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2905 automatically corrected.
2910 @node origin Reference
2911 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
2913 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2914 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2916 @deftp {Data Type} origin
2917 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2921 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2922 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2923 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2924 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2927 A procedure that handles the URI.
2932 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
2933 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
2937 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2938 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2939 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2940 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
2944 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2945 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2950 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2951 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2954 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
2955 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
2958 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2959 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2960 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2961 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
2962 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
2963 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2965 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2966 A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2968 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
2969 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
2970 @code{%current-target-system}.
2972 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2973 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
2974 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
2975 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2977 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2978 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2981 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2982 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2983 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2984 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2986 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2987 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2988 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2990 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2991 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2992 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2998 @section Build Systems
3000 @cindex build system
3001 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
3002 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
3003 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
3004 dependencies of that build procedure.
3006 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
3007 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
3008 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
3010 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
3011 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
3012 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
3013 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
3014 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
3015 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
3016 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
3018 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
3019 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
3020 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
3021 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
3022 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
3023 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
3024 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
3026 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
3027 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
3028 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
3030 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
3031 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
3032 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
3033 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
3035 @cindex build phases
3036 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
3037 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
3038 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
3039 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
3040 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
3041 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
3045 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
3046 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
3047 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
3049 @item patch-source-shebangs
3050 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
3051 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
3052 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
3055 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
3056 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
3057 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
3060 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
3061 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
3062 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
3065 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
3066 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
3067 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
3071 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
3073 @item patch-shebangs
3074 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
3077 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
3078 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
3079 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
3082 @vindex %standard-phases
3083 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
3084 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
3085 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
3086 procedure implements the actual phase.
3088 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
3089 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
3092 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
3095 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
3096 @code{configure} phase.
3098 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
3099 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
3100 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
3101 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
3102 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
3103 have to mention them.
3106 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
3107 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
3108 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
3109 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
3110 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
3112 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
3113 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
3114 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
3115 @url{http://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
3117 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
3118 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
3119 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
3120 parameters, respectively.
3122 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
3123 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
3124 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
3127 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
3128 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
3129 ``jar'' task will be run.
3133 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
3134 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
3135 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
3137 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
3138 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
3139 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
3140 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
3142 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
3143 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
3144 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
3145 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
3146 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
3147 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
3149 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
3150 package itself as well as its run-time dependencies should begin their
3151 name with the lisp implementation, such as @code{sbcl-} for
3152 @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}. Beginning the input name with this
3153 prefix will allow the build system to encode its location into the
3154 resulting library, so that the input can be found at run-time.
3156 If dependencies are used only for tests, it is convenient to use a
3157 different prefix in order to avoid having a run-time dependency on such
3158 systems. For example,
3161 (define-public sbcl-bordeaux-threads
3164 (native-inputs `(("tests:cl-fiveam" ,sbcl-fiveam)))
3168 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
3169 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
3170 the @code{cl-} prefix.
3172 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
3173 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
3174 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
3175 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
3177 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
3178 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
3179 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
3180 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
3181 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
3182 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
3184 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
3185 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
3186 which file the system is defined in.
3190 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
3191 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
3192 implements the build procedure for packages using the
3193 @url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
3195 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
3196 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
3199 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
3200 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
3201 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
3202 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
3203 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
3204 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
3207 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
3208 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
3209 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
3211 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
3212 @var{gnu-build-system}:
3215 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
3216 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
3217 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
3218 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
3219 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
3220 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
3221 environment variables.
3223 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
3224 process by listing their names in the
3225 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
3226 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
3227 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
3230 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
3231 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
3232 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
3233 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
3234 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
3235 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
3236 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
3237 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
3240 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
3243 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
3244 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
3245 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
3246 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
3247 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
3249 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
3250 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
3251 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
3253 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
3254 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
3255 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
3256 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
3257 interpreter version.
3259 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
3260 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
3261 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
3262 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools} parameter to @code{#f}.
3265 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
3266 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
3267 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
3268 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
3269 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
3270 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
3271 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
3272 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
3273 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
3274 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
3275 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
3276 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
3278 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
3279 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
3280 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
3282 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
3285 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
3286 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
3287 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
3288 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
3289 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
3290 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
3291 are run after installation using the R function
3292 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
3295 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
3296 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
3297 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
3298 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
3300 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
3301 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
3302 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
3303 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
3304 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
3305 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
3306 a traditional source release tarball.
3308 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
3309 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
3310 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
3313 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
3314 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
3315 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
3316 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
3317 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
3320 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
3321 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
3322 @code{#:python} parameter.
3325 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
3326 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
3327 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
3328 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
3329 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
3330 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
3331 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
3332 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
3333 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
3334 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
3335 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
3336 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
3337 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
3338 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
3340 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
3341 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
3344 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
3345 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
3346 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
3347 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
3349 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
3350 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
3351 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
3352 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
3353 package is installed in its own directory under
3354 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
3357 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
3358 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
3359 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
3360 and does not have a notion of build phases.
3362 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
3363 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
3365 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
3366 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
3367 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
3368 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
3378 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
3379 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
3380 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
3381 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
3382 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
3383 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
3384 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
3385 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
3386 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
3388 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
3389 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
3390 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
3391 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
3394 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
3395 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
3396 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
3398 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
3399 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
3400 accidental modifications.
3403 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
3404 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
3406 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
3407 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
3408 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
3409 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
3410 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
3412 @var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
3413 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
3416 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
3417 Close the connection to @var{server}.
3420 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
3421 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
3422 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
3425 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
3428 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
3429 @cindex invalid store items
3430 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
3431 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
3432 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
3435 A @code{&nix-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
3436 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
3439 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3440 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
3441 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
3442 resulting store path.
3445 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
3446 Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
3447 derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
3448 Return @code{#t} on success.
3451 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
3452 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
3453 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
3457 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
3460 @section Derivations
3463 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
3464 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
3465 following pieces of information:
3469 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
3470 directory in the store, but may produce more.
3473 The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
3474 files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
3477 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
3480 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
3484 A list of environment variables to be defined.
3488 @cindex derivation path
3489 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
3490 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
3491 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
3492 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
3493 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
3494 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
3497 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
3498 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
3499 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
3500 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
3502 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
3503 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3504 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
3505 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
3506 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3507 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
3508 [#:substitutable? #t]
3509 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
3510 @code{<derivation>} object.
3512 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
3513 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
3514 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
3515 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
3516 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
3517 containing this output.
3519 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
3520 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
3521 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
3522 a simple text format.
3524 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
3525 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
3526 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
3527 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
3529 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
3530 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
3531 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
3532 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
3533 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
3534 derivations that download files.
3536 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
3537 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
3538 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
3539 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
3541 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
3542 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
3543 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
3544 host CPU instruction set.
3548 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
3549 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
3550 to a Bash executable in the store:
3553 (use-modules (guix utils)
3557 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3558 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3559 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3560 (derivation store "foo"
3561 bash `("-e" ,builder)
3562 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
3563 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
3564 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
3567 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3568 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3569 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3570 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
3571 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
3573 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3574 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3575 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3576 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
3578 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3579 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3580 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3581 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3582 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
3583 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
3584 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3585 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
3586 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3587 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3588 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3589 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3590 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3591 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3592 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3593 gnu-build-system))}.
3595 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3596 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3597 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3598 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3599 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3600 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3601 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3603 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3604 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3605 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
3607 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
3608 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
3609 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
3610 @var{substitutable?}.
3614 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3615 containing one file:
3618 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
3619 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
3620 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3622 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
3623 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
3625 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
3629 @node The Store Monad
3630 @section The Store Monad
3634 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3635 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3636 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3637 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3639 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3640 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3641 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3642 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3643 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3645 @cindex monadic values
3646 @cindex monadic functions
3647 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3648 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3649 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3650 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3651 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
3652 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
3653 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3654 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3655 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
3657 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3660 (define (sh-symlink store)
3661 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3662 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3663 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3664 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3665 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3666 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
3669 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3670 as a monadic function:
3673 (define (sh-symlink)
3674 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
3675 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3676 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3677 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3681 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3682 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3683 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3684 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3685 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3687 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3688 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3689 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3692 (define (sh-symlink)
3693 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3694 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3699 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3700 @c for the funny quote.
3701 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3702 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3703 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3704 @code{run-with-store}:
3707 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3708 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
3711 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
3712 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
3713 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
3714 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3717 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3718 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3721 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3722 automatically run through the store:
3725 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3726 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3727 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3728 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3729 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3730 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3731 scheme@@(guile-user)>
3735 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3736 @code{store-monad} REPL.
3738 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3739 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
3741 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3742 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3746 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3747 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3750 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
3751 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
3752 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3753 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3754 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3755 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3760 (with-monad %state-monad
3762 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3763 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3767 @result{} some-state
3771 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3773 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3775 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3776 @var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3777 ``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3779 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3780 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3783 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3784 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3785 returning the result of the last expression.
3787 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3788 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3789 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3793 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3794 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3795 monadic procedure calls.
3797 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3798 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3799 the state that is threaded.
3801 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3802 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3803 increments the current state value:
3807 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3808 (mbegin %state-monad
3809 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3812 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3817 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3818 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3821 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3822 Return the current state as a monadic value.
3825 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3826 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3830 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3831 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3832 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3835 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3836 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3837 The state is assumed to be a list.
3840 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3841 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3842 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3845 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3846 store)} module, is as follows.
3848 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
3849 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3851 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3852 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3853 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
3856 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3857 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3858 open store connection.
3861 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3862 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
3863 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3864 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
3867 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3868 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
3869 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3870 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3871 @var{name} is omitted.
3873 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3874 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3875 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3877 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
3878 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
3879 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
3880 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
3882 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3885 (run-with-store (open-connection)
3886 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3887 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3888 (return (list a b))))
3890 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3895 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3898 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
3899 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
3902 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3903 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
3904 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3905 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
3908 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
3909 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3910 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3911 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3912 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3917 @section G-Expressions
3919 @cindex G-expression
3920 @cindex build code quoting
3921 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3922 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
3923 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
3924 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3925 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3927 @cindex strata of code
3928 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
3929 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3930 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
3931 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3932 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3933 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3934 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3935 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3936 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3937 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3938 @command{make}, etc.
3940 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3941 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
3942 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
3943 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
3944 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
3947 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3948 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
3949 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
3950 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
3951 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
3952 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
3953 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
3954 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
3958 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3962 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3963 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3967 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3968 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3969 processes that use them.
3972 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3973 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3974 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
3975 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3976 such that these objects can also be inserted
3977 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
3978 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
3979 add files to the store and to refer to them in
3980 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3983 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3990 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3994 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3995 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3996 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3999 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
4002 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
4003 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
4004 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
4005 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
4006 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
4007 output of the derivation.
4009 @cindex cross compilation
4010 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
4011 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
4012 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
4013 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
4014 native package build:
4017 (gexp->derivation "vi"
4020 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
4022 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
4023 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
4024 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
4028 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
4029 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
4030 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
4032 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
4033 @findex with-imported-modules
4034 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
4035 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
4036 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
4037 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
4040 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
4042 (use-modules (guix build utils))
4043 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
4044 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
4047 (display "success!\n")
4052 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
4053 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
4054 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
4056 @cindex module closure
4057 @findex source-module-closure
4058 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
4059 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
4060 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
4061 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
4062 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
4063 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
4066 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
4068 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
4069 '((guix build utils)
4071 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
4073 (use-modules (guix build utils)
4078 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
4080 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
4081 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
4082 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
4083 or more of the following forms:
4087 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
4088 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
4089 supported types, for example a package or a
4090 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
4091 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
4093 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
4094 objects are substituted similarly.
4096 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
4097 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
4099 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
4101 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
4102 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
4103 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
4104 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
4105 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4108 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
4109 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
4110 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
4111 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
4112 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
4114 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
4115 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
4116 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
4117 output when @var{output} is omitted.
4119 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
4122 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
4123 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
4127 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
4128 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
4133 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
4134 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
4137 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
4138 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
4139 in their execution environment. @var{modules} must be a list of Guile
4140 module names, such as @code{'((guix build utils) (guix build gremlin))}.
4142 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
4143 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
4144 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
4147 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
4148 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
4151 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
4152 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
4153 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
4154 information about monads.)
4156 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
4157 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
4158 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
4159 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
4160 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
4161 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
4162 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
4163 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
4164 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
4165 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
4166 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
4167 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
4168 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
4169 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
4172 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
4174 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
4175 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
4176 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
4177 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
4178 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
4180 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
4183 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
4187 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
4188 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
4189 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
4190 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
4191 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
4194 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
4195 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
4196 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
4199 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
4200 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
4201 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
4202 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
4203 referenced by the outputs.
4205 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
4208 @cindex file-like objects
4209 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
4210 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
4211 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
4212 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
4215 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
4216 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
4219 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
4220 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
4221 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
4222 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
4223 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
4224 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
4225 content is directly passed as a string.
4227 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
4228 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
4229 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
4230 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
4231 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
4232 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
4234 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
4235 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
4236 permission bits are kept.
4238 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
4239 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
4240 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
4241 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
4243 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
4244 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
4247 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
4248 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
4249 @var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
4251 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
4254 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
4255 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
4256 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
4257 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
4258 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
4260 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
4263 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
4264 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
4265 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
4267 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
4271 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
4273 (gexp->script "list-files"
4274 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
4278 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
4279 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
4280 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
4283 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
4285 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
4289 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4291 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
4292 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
4295 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
4298 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4299 [#:set-load-path? #t]
4300 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
4301 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
4302 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
4303 @var{exp}'s imported modules.
4305 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
4306 or a subset thereof.
4309 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
4310 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
4313 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
4316 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4317 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
4318 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
4319 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
4320 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
4321 references to all these.
4323 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
4324 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
4325 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
4329 (define (profile.sh)
4330 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
4331 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
4332 (text-file* "profile.sh"
4333 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
4334 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
4337 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
4338 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
4339 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
4342 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4343 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
4344 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
4348 (mixed-text-file "profile"
4349 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
4352 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
4355 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
4356 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
4357 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
4358 @var{suffix} is a string.
4360 As an example, consider this gexp:
4363 (gexp->script "run-uname"
4364 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
4368 The same effect could be achieved with:
4371 (gexp->script "run-uname"
4372 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
4376 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
4377 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
4378 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
4379 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
4383 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
4384 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
4385 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
4386 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
4388 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
4389 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
4390 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
4391 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
4392 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
4394 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
4396 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
4397 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
4398 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
4399 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
4403 @c *********************************************************************
4407 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
4408 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
4409 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
4410 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
4413 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
4414 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
4415 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
4416 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
4417 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
4418 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
4419 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
4420 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
4421 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
4422 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4423 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
4424 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
4425 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
4428 @node Invoking guix build
4429 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
4431 @cindex package building
4432 @cindex @command{guix build}
4433 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
4434 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
4435 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
4436 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
4437 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
4439 The general syntax is:
4442 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
4445 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
4446 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
4447 resulting directories:
4450 guix build emacs guile
4453 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
4456 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
4457 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
4460 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
4461 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
4462 @code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
4463 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
4464 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
4465 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4467 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
4468 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
4469 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
4472 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
4473 described in the subsections below.
4476 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
4477 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
4478 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
4481 @node Common Build Options
4482 @subsection Common Build Options
4484 A number of options that control the build process are common to
4485 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
4486 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
4491 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
4492 @itemx -L @var{directory}
4493 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
4494 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4496 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
4497 the command-line tools.
4501 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
4502 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
4503 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
4507 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
4508 all the builds have either completed or failed.
4510 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
4511 derivations has failed.
4515 Do not build the derivations.
4518 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
4521 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4522 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
4523 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
4524 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
4525 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
4527 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
4528 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
4529 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4531 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
4534 @item --no-substitutes
4535 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
4536 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
4537 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4540 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
4541 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4542 information on grafts.
4544 @item --rounds=@var{n}
4545 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
4546 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
4548 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
4549 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
4550 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
4551 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
4553 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
4554 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
4555 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
4556 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
4559 @item --no-build-hook
4560 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
4561 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
4562 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
4564 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
4565 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
4566 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4568 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
4569 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
4570 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4572 By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
4575 @item --verbosity=@var{level}
4576 Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
4577 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
4578 may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
4580 @item --cores=@var{n}
4582 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
4583 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
4585 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
4587 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
4588 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
4589 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
4593 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
4594 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
4595 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
4596 derivations)} module.
4598 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
4599 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
4600 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
4602 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
4603 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
4604 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
4605 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
4609 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
4612 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
4613 the parsed command-line options.
4617 @node Package Transformation Options
4618 @subsection Package Transformation Options
4620 @cindex package variants
4621 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
4622 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
4623 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
4624 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
4625 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
4626 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
4627 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4631 @item --with-source=@var{source}
4632 Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
4633 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
4634 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
4636 The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be the one specified on the
4637 command line the name of which matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
4638 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
4639 package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
4640 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
4642 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
4643 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
4644 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
4645 the @code{ed} package:
4648 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
4651 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
4655 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
4658 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
4661 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
4662 $ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
4665 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
4666 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
4667 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
4668 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
4669 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
4671 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
4672 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
4673 the development version of Guile, @code{guile-next}:
4676 guix build --with-input=guile=guile-next guix
4679 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
4680 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
4681 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile-next}.
4683 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
4684 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
4686 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
4687 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
4688 instead of rebuilding all the dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
4689 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
4690 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4691 information on grafts.
4693 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
4694 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
4695 they currently refer to:
4698 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
4701 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
4702 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
4703 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
4704 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
4705 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
4706 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
4711 @node Additional Build Options
4712 @subsection Additional Build Options
4714 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
4721 Build quietly, without displaying the build log. Upon completion, the
4722 build log is kept in @file{/var} (or similar) and can always be
4723 retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
4725 @item --file=@var{file}
4726 @itemx -f @var{file}
4728 Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
4731 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
4732 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4735 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
4738 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4739 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4740 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
4742 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
4743 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
4744 version 1.8 of Guile.
4746 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
4747 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
4748 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
4750 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
4751 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
4752 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
4756 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
4759 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
4760 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
4763 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
4764 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
4768 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
4769 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
4770 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
4771 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
4772 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
4773 optional argument values:
4777 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
4778 as the @code{--source} option.
4781 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
4782 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
4785 $ guix build --sources tzdata
4786 The following derivations will be built:
4787 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
4788 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4792 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
4793 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g. to
4794 prefetch package source for later offline building.
4797 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
4798 The following derivations will be built:
4799 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4800 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
4801 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
4802 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
4803 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
4804 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
4810 @item --system=@var{system}
4811 @itemx -s @var{system}
4812 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4813 the system type of the build host.
4815 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
4816 different personalities. For instance, passing
4817 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
4818 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
4820 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4821 @cindex cross-compilation
4822 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4823 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
4824 configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
4826 @anchor{build-check}
4828 @cindex determinism, checking
4829 @cindex reproducibility, checking
4830 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
4831 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
4834 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
4835 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
4836 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
4837 background information and tools.
4839 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
4840 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
4841 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
4845 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
4848 @item --root=@var{file}
4849 @itemx -r @var{file}
4850 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
4854 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
4855 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
4858 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
4859 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
4862 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
4863 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
4864 guix build --log-file guile
4865 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
4868 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
4869 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
4870 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
4872 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
4873 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
4876 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
4877 https://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
4880 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
4884 @node Invoking guix edit
4885 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4887 @cindex @command{guix edit}
4888 @cindex package definition, editing
4889 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4890 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
4891 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
4895 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
4899 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4900 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
4903 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
4904 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
4905 (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will be able to edit the package
4906 recipes. Otherwise, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
4907 for packages currently in the store.
4909 If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides the
4910 @kbd{M-x guix-edit} command and a similar functionality in the ``package
4911 info'' and ``package list'' buffers created by the @kbd{M-x
4912 guix-search-by-name} and similar commands (@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
4915 @node Invoking guix download
4916 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
4918 @cindex @command{guix download}
4919 @cindex downloading package sources
4920 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
4921 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
4922 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4923 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4924 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4925 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4927 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4928 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4929 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4930 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4931 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4932 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4934 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4935 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4936 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4937 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
4938 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4939 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4940 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
4942 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
4943 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
4944 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
4945 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
4947 The following options are available:
4950 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4952 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
4953 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
4955 @item --no-check-certificate
4956 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
4958 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
4959 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
4960 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
4962 @item --output=@var{file}
4963 @itemx -o @var{file}
4964 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
4968 @node Invoking guix hash
4969 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4971 @cindex @command{guix hash}
4972 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
4973 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4974 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4975 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4977 The general syntax is:
4980 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4983 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
4984 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
4989 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4991 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
4993 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4994 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4996 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4997 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4998 in the definitions of packages.
5002 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
5004 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
5005 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
5006 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
5007 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
5008 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
5009 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
5010 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
5015 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
5016 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
5019 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
5020 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
5024 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
5030 @node Invoking guix import
5031 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
5033 @cindex importing packages
5034 @cindex package import
5035 @cindex package conversion
5036 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
5037 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
5038 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
5039 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
5040 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
5041 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
5042 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5044 The general syntax is:
5047 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
5050 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
5051 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
5052 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
5057 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
5058 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
5059 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
5061 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
5062 license needs to be figured out manually.
5064 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
5068 guix import gnu hello
5071 Specific command-line options are:
5074 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
5075 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
5076 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
5077 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
5082 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
5083 Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
5084 @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
5085 description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
5086 the relevant information, including package dependencies. For maximum
5087 efficiency, it is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so
5088 that the importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
5090 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
5094 guix import pypi itsdangerous
5099 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
5100 RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
5101 installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
5102 JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
5103 most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
5104 some caveats, however. The metadata doesn't distinguish between
5105 synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
5106 Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
5107 native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
5110 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
5113 guix import gem rails
5118 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}@footnote{This
5119 functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
5120 @xref{Requirements}.}.
5121 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
5122 @uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
5123 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
5124 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
5125 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
5126 list of dependencies.
5128 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
5132 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
5137 @cindex Bioconductor
5138 Import metadata from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
5139 central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
5140 statistical and graphical environment}.
5142 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
5144 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
5148 guix import cran Cairo
5151 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
5152 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
5153 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
5155 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
5156 @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
5157 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
5158 genomic data in bioinformatics.
5160 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
5161 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
5163 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
5167 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
5171 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
5172 @uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
5173 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
5174 @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
5175 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
5176 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
5177 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
5180 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
5181 by their canonical upstream variant.
5183 Usually, you will first need to do:
5186 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
5190 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
5192 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
5193 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
5194 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
5197 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
5202 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
5203 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
5204 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
5207 Specific command-line options are:
5212 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
5213 @item --no-test-dependencies
5215 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
5216 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
5217 @itemx -e @var{alist}
5218 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
5219 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
5220 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
5221 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
5222 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
5223 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
5224 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
5225 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
5228 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
5229 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
5230 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
5233 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
5236 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
5237 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
5240 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
5245 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
5246 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
5248 Specific command-line options are:
5251 @item --archive=@var{repo}
5252 @itemx -a @var{repo}
5253 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
5254 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
5258 @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
5259 identifier. This is the default.
5261 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
5262 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
5263 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
5264 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
5265 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
5268 @uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
5269 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
5272 @uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
5279 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
5280 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}.
5283 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
5284 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
5285 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
5287 @node Invoking guix refresh
5288 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
5290 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
5291 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
5292 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
5293 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
5294 upstream version, like this:
5298 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
5299 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
5302 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
5303 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
5306 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
5307 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
5308 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
5311 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
5312 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
5313 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
5314 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
5315 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
5316 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
5317 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
5319 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
5320 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
5321 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
5322 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
5323 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
5324 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
5325 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
5326 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
5327 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
5328 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
5330 The following options are supported:
5334 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5335 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5336 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5338 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
5341 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
5344 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
5349 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
5350 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
5351 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
5354 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
5357 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
5359 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
5360 @itemx -s @var{subset}
5361 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
5364 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
5365 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
5366 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
5367 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
5368 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
5369 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
5371 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
5372 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
5375 @item --type=@var{updater}
5376 @itemx -t @var{updater}
5377 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
5378 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
5382 the updater for GNU packages;
5384 the updater for GNOME packages;
5386 the updater for KDE packages;
5388 the updater for X.org packages;
5390 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
5392 the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
5394 the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
5396 the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
5398 the updater for @uref{http://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
5400 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
5402 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
5404 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
5406 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
5408 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
5411 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
5412 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
5415 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
5416 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
5417 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
5422 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
5423 names, as in this example:
5426 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
5430 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
5431 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
5432 effect in this case.
5434 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
5435 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
5436 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
5437 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
5441 @item --list-updaters
5443 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
5445 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
5446 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
5448 @item --list-dependent
5450 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
5451 result of upgrading one or more packages.
5455 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
5456 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
5457 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
5460 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
5461 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
5462 hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
5465 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
5466 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
5468 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
5472 @item --gpg=@var{command}
5473 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
5474 for in @code{$PATH}.
5476 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
5477 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
5482 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
5483 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
5486 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
5489 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
5490 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
5493 @item --key-server=@var{host}
5494 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
5498 The @code{github} updater uses the
5499 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
5500 releases. When used repeatedly e.g. when refreshing all packages,
5501 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
5502 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
5503 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
5504 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
5505 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
5506 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
5510 @node Invoking guix lint
5511 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
5513 @cindex @command{guix lint}
5514 @cindex package, checking for errors
5515 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
5516 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
5517 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
5518 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
5519 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
5524 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
5525 descriptions and synopses.
5527 @item inputs-should-be-native
5528 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
5533 @itemx source-file-name
5534 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
5535 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. Check that
5536 the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
5537 just a version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared
5538 @code{file-name} (@pxref{origin Reference}).
5541 @cindex security vulnerabilities
5542 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
5543 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
5544 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
5545 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
5548 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
5552 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5554 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5558 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
5559 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
5561 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
5562 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
5563 name and version of the package when they differ from the name that Guix
5564 uses, as in this example:
5570 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
5571 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2"))))
5575 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
5576 use of tabulations, etc.
5579 The general syntax is:
5582 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5585 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
5586 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
5589 @item --list-checkers
5591 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
5596 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
5597 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
5601 @node Invoking guix size
5602 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
5605 @cindex package size
5607 @cindex @command{guix size}
5608 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
5609 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
5610 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
5611 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
5612 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
5613 @command{guix size} can highlight.
5615 The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
5616 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
5620 $ guix size coreutils
5621 store item total self
5622 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
5623 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
5624 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
5625 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
5626 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
5627 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
5631 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
5632 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
5633 would be returned by:
5636 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
5639 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
5640 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
5641 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
5642 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
5643 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
5644 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
5646 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
5647 70@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
5648 large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
5649 always available on the system anyway.)
5651 When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
5652 store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
5653 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
5654 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
5657 When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
5658 reports information based on the available substitutes
5659 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
5660 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
5662 You can also specify several package names:
5665 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
5666 store item total self
5667 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
5668 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
5669 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
5670 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
5676 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
5677 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
5678 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
5680 The available options are:
5684 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5685 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
5686 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
5688 @item --map-file=@var{file}
5689 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
5691 For the example above, the map looks like this:
5693 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
5694 produced by @command{guix size}}
5696 This option requires that
5697 @uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
5698 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
5699 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
5701 @item --system=@var{system}
5702 @itemx -s @var{system}
5703 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
5707 @node Invoking guix graph
5708 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
5711 @cindex @command{guix graph}
5712 @cindex package dependencies
5713 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
5714 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
5715 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
5716 provides a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix graph}
5717 emits a DAG representation in the input format of
5718 @uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
5719 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. The general
5723 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5726 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
5727 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
5731 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5734 The output looks like this:
5736 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5738 Nice little graph, no?
5740 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
5741 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
5742 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
5743 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
5744 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
5748 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
5749 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
5750 filters out many details.
5753 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
5755 For instance, the following command:
5758 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5761 ... yields this bigger graph:
5763 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5765 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
5766 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
5768 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
5769 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
5770 here, for conciseness.
5773 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
5776 @item bag-with-origins
5777 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
5780 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
5781 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
5782 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
5783 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
5785 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
5786 name instead of a package name, as in:
5789 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
5793 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
5794 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
5798 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
5799 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
5801 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
5802 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
5804 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
5805 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
5806 (which can be big!):
5809 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
5813 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
5814 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
5816 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
5817 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
5818 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
5819 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
5822 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
5827 The available options are the following:
5830 @item --type=@var{type}
5831 @itemx -t @var{type}
5832 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
5833 the values listed above.
5836 List the supported graph types.
5838 @item --backend=@var{backend}
5839 @itemx -b @var{backend}
5840 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
5842 @item --list-backends
5843 List the supported graph backends.
5845 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5846 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5847 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5849 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
5852 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
5857 @node Invoking guix environment
5858 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5860 @cindex reproducible build environments
5861 @cindex development environments
5862 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5863 @cindex environment, package build environment
5864 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5865 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5866 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5867 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5868 environment to use them.
5870 The general syntax is:
5873 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5876 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5880 guix environment guile
5883 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5884 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
5885 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
5886 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
5887 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
5888 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
5889 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
5890 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
5891 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
5892 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
5893 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
5894 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
5895 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
5896 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
5897 details on Bash start-up files.}.
5899 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5900 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5901 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5902 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5903 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5904 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5907 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5909 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5914 ... or to browse the profile:
5917 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5920 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5921 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5922 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5923 and Emacs are available:
5926 guix environment guile emacs
5929 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5930 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5931 command from the rest of the arguments:
5934 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5937 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5938 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5939 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5943 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5946 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5947 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5948 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5949 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5950 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5951 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5952 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5953 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5954 additionally includes Git and strace:
5957 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
5960 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5961 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5962 using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
5963 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5964 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5965 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5966 working directory are mounted:
5969 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5973 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5976 The available options are summarized below.
5979 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5980 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5981 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5982 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5984 For example, running:
5987 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5990 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5996 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5999 starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
6001 The above commands only the use default output of the given packages.
6002 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
6005 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
6008 @item --load=@var{file}
6009 @itemx -l @var{file}
6010 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
6011 within @var{file} evaluates to.
6013 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
6014 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
6017 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
6021 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
6022 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
6023 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
6024 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
6026 For instance, the command:
6029 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
6032 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
6035 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
6036 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
6037 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
6038 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
6040 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
6041 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
6042 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
6043 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
6044 that will be added to the environment directly.
6047 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
6048 This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
6049 only contain package inputs.
6051 @item --search-paths
6052 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
6055 @item --system=@var{system}
6056 @itemx -s @var{system}
6057 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
6062 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
6063 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
6064 Additionally, a dummy home directory is created that matches the current
6065 user's home directory, and @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
6066 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container, but
6067 has root privileges in the context of the container.
6071 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
6072 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
6075 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
6076 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
6077 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
6078 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
6079 point in the container.
6081 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
6082 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
6086 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
6089 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
6090 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
6091 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
6092 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
6093 point in the container.
6095 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
6096 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
6097 @file{/exchange} directory:
6100 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
6104 It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
6105 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
6107 @node Invoking guix publish
6108 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
6110 @cindex @command{guix publish}
6111 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
6112 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
6113 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
6115 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
6116 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
6117 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
6118 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
6119 the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
6121 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
6122 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
6123 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
6124 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
6125 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
6127 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
6128 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
6131 The general syntax is:
6134 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
6137 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
6138 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
6144 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
6145 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
6148 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
6151 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
6152 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
6153 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
6154 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
6155 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
6156 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
6159 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
6162 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
6163 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
6165 The following options are available:
6168 @item --port=@var{port}
6169 @itemx -p @var{port}
6170 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
6172 @item --listen=@var{host}
6173 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
6174 accept connections from any interface.
6176 @item --user=@var{user}
6177 @itemx -u @var{user}
6178 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
6179 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
6181 @item --compression[=@var{level}]
6182 @itemx -C [@var{level}]
6183 Compress data using the given @var{level}. When @var{level} is zero,
6184 disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds to different gzip
6185 compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best (CPU-intensive).
6188 Compression occurs on the fly and the compressed streams are not
6189 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
6190 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, or to
6191 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy.
6193 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
6194 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
6195 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
6196 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
6198 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
6199 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
6200 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
6201 for as long as @var{ttl}.
6203 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
6204 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
6205 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
6206 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
6207 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
6210 Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
6211 add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
6212 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
6213 @code{guix-publish-service}}).
6215 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
6220 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
6223 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
6224 /etc/systemd/system/
6225 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
6229 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
6232 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
6233 # start guix-publish
6237 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
6240 @node Invoking guix challenge
6241 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
6243 @cindex reproducible builds
6244 @cindex verifiable builds
6245 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
6247 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
6248 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
6249 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
6252 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
6253 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
6254 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
6255 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
6256 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
6257 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
6258 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
6260 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
6261 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
6262 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
6263 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
6264 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
6265 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
6266 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
6267 any given store item.
6269 The command output looks like this:
6272 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://hydra.gnu.org https://guix.example.org"
6273 updating list of substitutes from 'https://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
6274 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
6275 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
6276 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
6277 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
6278 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
6279 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
6280 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
6281 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
6282 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
6283 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
6284 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
6285 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
6286 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
6290 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
6291 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
6292 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
6293 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
6294 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
6296 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
6297 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
6298 Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
6299 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
6300 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
6301 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
6302 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
6303 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
6304 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
6305 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
6308 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
6309 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
6312 $ wget -q -O - https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
6313 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
6314 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
6317 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
6318 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
6319 @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
6320 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
6321 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
6322 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
6323 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
6325 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
6326 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
6327 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
6328 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
6329 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
6330 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
6333 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
6334 whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
6335 same build result as you did with:
6338 $ guix challenge @var{package}
6342 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
6343 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
6345 The general syntax is:
6348 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
6351 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
6352 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
6353 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
6354 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
6357 The one option that matters is:
6361 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
6362 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
6368 @node Invoking guix container
6369 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
6371 @cindex @command{guix container}
6373 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
6374 is subject to radical change in the future.
6377 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
6378 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
6379 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
6380 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
6381 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
6383 The general syntax is:
6386 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
6389 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
6390 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
6392 The following actions are available:
6396 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
6401 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
6404 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
6405 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
6406 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
6407 will be passed to @var{program}.
6409 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
6410 GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
6414 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
6417 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
6418 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
6422 @c *********************************************************************
6423 @node GNU Distribution
6424 @chapter GNU Distribution
6426 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6428 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
6429 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
6430 @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
6431 users of that software}.}. The
6432 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
6433 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
6434 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
6435 between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
6436 System Distribution, or GuixSD.
6438 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
6439 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
6440 list of available packages can be browsed
6441 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
6442 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
6445 guix package --list-available
6448 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
6449 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
6450 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
6451 tools that help users exert that freedom.
6453 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
6458 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
6461 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
6464 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
6465 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
6466 and Linux-Libre kernel.
6468 @item mips64el-linux
6469 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
6470 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
6474 GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
6477 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
6481 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
6482 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
6483 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
6484 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
6485 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6486 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
6487 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
6488 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
6491 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
6492 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
6494 @node System Installation
6495 @section System Installation
6497 @cindex installing GuixSD
6498 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6499 This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD)
6500 on a machine. The Guix package manager can
6501 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
6502 @pxref{Installation}.
6506 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
6507 @c installation image.
6508 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
6509 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6510 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
6511 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
6513 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
6519 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
6520 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
6521 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
6522 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
6523 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
6524 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
6525 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
6529 @subsection Limitations
6531 As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
6532 not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
6533 features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
6534 respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
6535 is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
6536 the more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
6537 to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
6538 also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
6539 of it (@pxref{Installation}).
6541 Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
6542 noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
6546 The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
6547 requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
6548 get a feel of what that means.)
6551 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
6554 Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
6558 More than 4,000 packages are available, but you may
6559 occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
6562 GNOME, Xfce, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
6563 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, some graphical
6564 applications may be missing, as well as KDE.
6567 You have been warned! But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
6568 to report issues (and success stories!), and to join us in improving it.
6569 @xref{Contributing}, for more info.
6572 @node Hardware Considerations
6573 @subsection Hardware Considerations
6575 @cindex hardware support on GuixSD
6576 GNU@tie{}GuixSD focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
6577 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
6578 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
6579 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
6580 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
6581 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
6582 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
6583 hardware is not supported on GuixSD.
6585 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
6586 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
6587 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
6588 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
6589 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
6590 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
6591 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
6592 out-of-the-box on GuixSD, as part of @var{%base-firmware}
6593 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
6595 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
6596 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
6597 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
6598 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
6599 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
6600 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
6602 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
6603 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
6604 about their support in GNU/Linux.
6607 @node USB Stick Installation
6608 @subsection USB Stick Installation
6610 An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
6611 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
6612 where @var{system} is one of:
6616 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
6619 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
6622 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
6623 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
6624 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
6627 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6628 $ gpg --verify guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6631 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
6632 then run this command to import it:
6635 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
6639 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
6642 This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
6643 installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
6646 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
6650 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
6653 xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
6657 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
6658 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
6659 copy the image with:
6662 dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
6665 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
6668 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
6669 the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
6670 menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
6672 @xref{Installing GuixSD in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
6673 GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM).
6675 @node Preparing for Installation
6676 @subsection Preparing for Installation
6678 Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
6679 end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
6680 be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
6681 browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
6682 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse
6683 daemon, which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and
6684 to paste it with the middle button.
6687 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
6688 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
6689 ``Networking'' section below.
6692 The installation system includes many common tools needed for this task.
6693 But it is also a full-blown GuixSD system, which means that you can
6694 install additional packages, should you need it, using @command{guix
6695 package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
6697 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
6699 @cindex keyboard layout
6700 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
6701 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
6702 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
6708 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
6709 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
6712 @subsubsection Networking
6714 Run the following command see what your network interfaces are called:
6721 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
6727 @c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
6728 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
6729 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
6730 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
6731 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
6734 @item Wired connection
6735 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
6736 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
6739 ifconfig @var{interface} up
6742 @item Wireless connection
6745 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
6746 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
6747 important) using one of the available text editors such as
6751 zile wpa_supplicant.conf
6754 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
6755 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
6756 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
6760 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
6762 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
6766 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
6767 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
6768 network interface you want to use):
6771 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
6774 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
6778 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
6779 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
6782 dhclient -v @var{interface}
6785 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
6791 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
6792 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
6794 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
6796 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
6797 then format the target partition(s).
6799 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
6800 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
6801 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
6802 the partition layout you want:
6808 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
6809 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
6810 GuixSD pretty much assumes an ext4 file system. In particular, code
6811 that reads partition UUIDs and labels only works with ext4. This will
6812 be fixed in the future.}.
6814 Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
6815 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
6816 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
6817 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
6818 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda1}, a file system with the label
6819 @code{my-root} can be created with:
6822 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda1
6825 @cindex encrypted disk
6826 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
6827 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
6828 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
6829 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
6830 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda1}, the command sequence would
6831 be along these lines:
6834 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda1
6835 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda1 my-partition
6836 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
6839 Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}
6840 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
6844 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
6847 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
6848 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
6849 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
6850 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, you would run:
6856 @node Proceeding with the Installation
6857 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
6859 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
6860 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
6863 herd start cow-store /mnt
6866 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
6867 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
6868 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
6869 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
6870 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
6872 Next, you have to edit a file and
6873 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
6874 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors: GNU nano
6875 (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
6876 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
6877 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
6878 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
6879 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
6881 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
6882 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
6883 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
6884 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
6885 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
6886 something along these lines:
6890 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
6891 # zile /mnt/etc/config.scm
6894 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
6899 Make sure the @code{grub-configuration} form refers to the device you
6900 want to install GRUB on.
6903 Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
6904 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
6905 your @code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
6909 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
6910 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
6913 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
6914 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
6918 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
6922 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
6923 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6924 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
6925 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
6927 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
6928 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
6929 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
6930 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
6931 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
6932 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
6934 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
6935 @file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
6938 @node Installing GuixSD in a VM
6939 @subsection Installing GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
6941 @cindex virtual machine, GuixSD installation
6942 If you'd like to install GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) rather than on
6943 your beloved machine, this section is for you.
6945 To boot a @uref{http://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing GuixSD in a
6946 disk image, follow these steps:
6950 First, retrieve the GuixSD installation image as described previously
6951 (@pxref{USB Stick Installation}).
6954 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
6955 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
6958 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 5G
6961 This will create a 5GB file.
6964 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
6967 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 \
6968 -net default -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
6969 -drive file=guixsd.img \
6970 -drive file=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}
6973 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
6974 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
6978 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
6979 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
6982 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
6983 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM}, for how to do
6986 @node Building the Installation Image
6987 @subsection Building the Installation Image
6989 @cindex installation image
6990 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
6991 system} command, specifically:
6993 @c FIXME: 1G is too much; see <http://bugs.gnu.org/23077>.
6995 guix system disk-image --image-size=1G gnu/system/install.scm
6998 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
6999 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
7000 about the installation image.
7002 @node System Configuration
7003 @section System Configuration
7005 @cindex system configuration
7006 The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
7007 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
7008 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
7009 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
7010 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
7012 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
7013 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
7014 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
7015 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
7016 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
7017 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
7018 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
7019 the own tools of the system.
7020 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
7022 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
7023 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
7024 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
7025 instance to support new system services.
7028 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
7029 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
7030 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
7031 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
7032 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
7033 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
7034 * Services:: Specifying system services.
7035 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
7036 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
7037 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
7038 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
7039 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
7040 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
7041 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
7042 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
7045 @node Using the Configuration System
7046 @subsection Using the Configuration System
7048 The operating system is configured by providing an
7049 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
7050 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
7051 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
7052 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
7054 @findex operating-system
7056 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
7059 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
7060 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
7061 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
7062 which case they get a default value.
7064 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
7065 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
7066 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
7067 @command{guix system}.
7069 @unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
7071 @vindex %base-packages
7072 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
7073 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
7074 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
7075 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
7076 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
7077 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
7078 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
7079 etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
7080 packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7082 @findex specification->package
7083 Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
7084 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
7085 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
7086 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
7087 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
7088 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
7089 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
7093 (use-modules (gnu packages))
7097 (packages (append (map specification->package
7098 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
7102 @unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
7105 @vindex %base-services
7106 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
7107 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
7108 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
7109 addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
7110 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
7111 @code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
7112 @code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
7113 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
7114 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
7116 @cindex customization, of services
7117 @findex modify-services
7118 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
7119 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
7120 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
7122 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
7123 (the console log-in) in the @var{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
7124 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
7125 following in your operating system declaration:
7128 (define %my-services
7129 ;; My very own list of services.
7130 (modify-services %base-services
7131 (guix-service-type config =>
7134 (use-substitutes? #f)
7135 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
7136 (mingetty-service-type config =>
7137 (mingetty-configuration
7138 (inherit config)))))
7142 (services %my-services))
7145 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
7146 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
7147 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @var{%base-services} list.
7148 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
7149 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
7150 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
7151 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
7152 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
7153 configuration, but with a few modifications.
7155 @cindex encrypted disk
7156 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
7157 root partition, the X11 display
7158 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
7159 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
7160 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
7163 @include os-config-desktop.texi
7166 A graphical environment with a choice of lightweight window managers
7167 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
7170 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
7173 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
7174 @var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
7175 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
7177 Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
7178 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
7179 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
7180 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
7181 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
7182 @var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
7185 (remove (lambda (service)
7186 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
7190 @unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
7192 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
7193 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
7194 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
7195 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
7196 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
7198 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
7199 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
7200 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
7201 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
7202 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
7203 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
7204 system, should you ever need to.
7206 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
7207 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
7208 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
7209 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
7210 an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
7211 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
7212 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
7213 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
7214 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
7215 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
7217 Although the command @command{guix system reconfigure} will not modify
7218 previous generations, must take care when the current generation is not
7219 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
7220 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
7223 @unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
7225 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
7226 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
7229 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
7230 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
7231 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
7233 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
7234 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
7235 instantiate @var{os}.
7238 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
7239 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
7240 guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
7243 @node operating-system Reference
7244 @subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
7246 This section summarizes all the options available in
7247 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
7250 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
7251 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
7252 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
7253 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
7256 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
7257 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
7258 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
7259 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
7261 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
7262 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
7263 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
7265 @item @code{bootloader}
7266 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
7268 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
7270 @cindex initial RAM disk
7271 A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
7272 the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
7274 @item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
7276 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
7278 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
7279 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
7280 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
7283 @item @code{host-name}
7286 @item @code{hosts-file}
7288 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
7289 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7290 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
7291 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
7293 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
7294 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
7296 @item @code{file-systems}
7297 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
7299 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
7300 @cindex swap devices
7301 A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
7302 (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7303 For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
7305 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
7306 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
7307 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
7309 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
7310 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
7311 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
7312 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
7314 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
7317 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
7318 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
7319 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
7320 (activate-readline)")))
7323 @item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
7324 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
7325 displayed when users log in on a text console.
7327 @item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
7328 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
7329 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
7331 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
7332 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
7335 @item @code{timezone}
7336 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
7338 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
7339 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
7340 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
7342 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
7343 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
7344 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
7346 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
7347 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
7348 run time. @xref{Locales}.
7350 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
7351 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
7352 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
7353 considerations that justify this option.
7355 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
7356 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
7357 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
7360 @item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
7361 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
7363 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
7365 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
7366 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
7367 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
7369 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
7370 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
7371 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
7373 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
7374 @cindex sudoers file
7375 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
7376 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
7378 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
7379 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
7380 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
7387 @subsection File Systems
7389 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
7390 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
7391 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
7392 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
7396 (mount-point "/home")
7397 (device "/dev/sda3")
7401 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
7402 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
7404 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
7405 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
7406 contain the following members:
7410 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
7413 @item @code{mount-point}
7414 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
7417 This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
7418 of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
7419 field described below.
7421 @item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
7422 This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
7425 When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
7426 interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
7427 is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
7428 @code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
7430 UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
7431 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
7432 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
7433 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
7434 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
7435 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
7440 (mount-point "/home")
7443 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
7446 The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
7447 partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
7448 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
7449 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
7450 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
7451 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
7454 However, when the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
7455 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
7456 device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
7457 @code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
7458 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
7459 corresponding device mapping established.
7461 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
7462 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
7463 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
7464 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
7465 bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
7467 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
7468 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
7470 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
7471 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
7472 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
7473 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
7474 is not automatically mounted.
7476 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
7477 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
7478 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
7479 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
7480 instance, for the root file system.
7482 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
7483 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
7484 errors before being mounted.
7486 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
7487 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
7489 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
7490 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
7491 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
7492 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
7494 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
7495 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
7496 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
7498 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
7499 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
7503 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
7506 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
7507 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
7508 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
7509 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
7513 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
7514 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
7515 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
7516 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
7517 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
7521 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
7522 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
7523 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
7524 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7527 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
7528 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
7529 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
7530 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
7531 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
7533 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
7534 read-write in its own ``name space.''
7537 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
7538 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
7539 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
7540 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7543 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
7544 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
7545 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
7546 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7549 @node Mapped Devices
7550 @subsection Mapped Devices
7552 @cindex device mapping
7553 @cindex mapped devices
7554 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
7555 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
7556 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
7557 with additional processing over the data that flows through
7558 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
7559 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
7560 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
7561 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
7562 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
7563 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
7564 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
7565 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
7566 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
7567 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
7568 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
7569 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
7570 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
7572 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
7573 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
7575 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
7576 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
7577 the system boots up.
7581 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
7582 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
7583 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
7586 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
7587 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
7588 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
7589 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
7590 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
7591 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
7594 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
7595 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
7599 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
7600 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
7601 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
7602 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
7605 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
7606 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
7607 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
7608 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
7609 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
7612 @cindex disk encryption
7614 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
7615 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
7616 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
7617 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
7618 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
7619 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
7620 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7624 (source "/dev/sda3")
7626 (type luks-device-mapping))
7629 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
7630 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
7634 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
7637 and use it as follows:
7641 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
7643 (type luks-device-mapping))
7646 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
7647 may be declared as follows:
7651 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
7653 (type raid-device-mapping))
7656 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
7657 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7658 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
7659 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
7660 automatically later.
7664 @subsection User Accounts
7668 @cindex user accounts
7669 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
7670 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
7671 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
7677 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
7679 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
7680 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
7681 (comment "Bob's sister")
7682 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
7685 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
7686 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
7687 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
7688 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
7689 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
7690 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
7693 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
7694 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
7699 The name of the user account.
7703 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
7704 this account belongs to.
7706 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
7707 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
7710 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
7711 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
7712 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
7715 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
7716 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
7718 @item @code{home-directory}
7719 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
7721 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
7722 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
7723 if it does not exist yet.
7725 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
7726 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
7727 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
7729 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7730 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
7731 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
7732 graphical login managers do not list them.
7734 @anchor{user-account-password}
7735 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7736 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
7737 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
7738 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
7739 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
7742 If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
7743 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
7744 @xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
7745 on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7746 Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
7752 User group declarations are even simpler:
7755 (user-group (name "students"))
7758 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
7759 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
7763 The name of the group.
7765 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
7766 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
7767 automatically allocated when the group is created.
7769 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7770 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
7771 System groups have low numerical IDs.
7773 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7774 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
7775 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
7780 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
7783 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
7784 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
7785 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
7786 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
7787 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
7790 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
7791 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
7792 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
7794 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
7795 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
7802 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
7803 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7804 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
7805 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
7806 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
7807 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
7809 @cindex locale definition
7810 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
7811 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
7812 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
7814 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
7815 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
7816 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
7817 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
7818 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
7819 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
7820 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
7821 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
7823 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
7827 (cons (locale-definition
7828 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
7829 %default-locale-definitions)
7832 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
7833 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
7836 (list (locale-definition
7837 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
7838 (charset "EUC-JP")))
7842 The compiled locale definitions are available at
7843 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
7844 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
7845 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
7846 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7847 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7849 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
7850 locale)} module. Details are given below.
7852 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
7853 This is the data type of a locale definition.
7858 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7859 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
7862 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
7863 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
7865 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
7866 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
7867 @uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
7873 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
7874 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
7875 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
7879 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
7880 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
7881 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
7882 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
7883 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
7887 @subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
7889 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
7890 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
7891 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
7892 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
7893 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
7894 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
7897 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
7898 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
7899 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
7900 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
7901 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
7902 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
7903 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
7904 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
7905 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
7906 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
7907 programs will not abort.
7909 The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
7910 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
7911 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
7912 used to build the system-wide locale data.
7914 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
7915 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7916 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7918 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
7919 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
7920 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
7921 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
7922 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
7923 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
7926 (use-package-modules base)
7930 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
7933 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
7934 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
7935 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
7939 @subsection Services
7941 @cindex system services
7942 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
7943 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
7944 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
7945 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
7946 configuring network access.
7948 GuixSD has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
7949 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
7950 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
7951 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
7952 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
7953 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
7959 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
7960 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
7965 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
7968 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
7969 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
7970 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
7974 Service nscd has been stopped.
7975 # herd restart xorg-server
7976 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
7977 Service xorg-server has been started.
7980 The following sections document the available services, starting with
7981 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
7985 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
7986 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
7987 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
7988 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
7989 * X Window:: Graphical display.
7990 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
7991 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
7992 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
7993 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
7994 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
7995 * Web Services:: Web servers.
7996 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
7997 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
7998 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
8002 @subsubsection Base Services
8004 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
8005 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
8006 this module are listed below.
8008 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
8009 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
8010 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
8011 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
8012 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
8015 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
8016 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
8017 system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
8021 (cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
8025 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
8026 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
8029 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
8030 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
8031 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
8035 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
8036 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
8041 @cindex message of the day
8042 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
8044 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
8045 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
8046 the 'root' account has just been created.
8051 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
8052 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
8053 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
8057 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
8058 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
8059 implements console log-in.
8064 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
8066 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
8067 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
8068 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
8069 user name and password must be entered to log in.
8071 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
8072 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
8073 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
8074 the name of the log-in program.
8076 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
8077 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
8078 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
8080 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
8081 The Mingetty package to use.
8086 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
8087 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
8088 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
8089 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
8092 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
8093 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
8094 implements console log-in.
8098 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
8099 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
8101 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
8102 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
8103 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
8105 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
8106 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
8108 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
8109 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
8111 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
8112 The Kmscon package to use.
8117 @cindex name service cache daemon
8119 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
8120 [#:name-services '()]
8121 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
8122 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
8123 Service Switch}, for an example.
8126 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
8127 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
8128 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
8129 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
8132 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
8133 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
8138 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
8139 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
8140 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
8142 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
8143 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
8146 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
8147 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
8148 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
8150 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
8151 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
8152 debugging output is logged.
8154 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
8155 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
8161 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
8162 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
8166 @item @code{database}
8167 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
8168 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
8169 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
8170 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8172 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
8173 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
8174 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
8175 negative lookup result remains in cache.
8177 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
8178 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
8181 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
8182 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
8185 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
8186 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
8188 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
8189 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
8191 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
8192 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
8194 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
8195 @c settings, so leave them out.
8200 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
8201 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
8202 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
8204 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
8205 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
8206 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
8207 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
8208 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
8211 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
8214 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
8215 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
8218 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
8219 The syslog daemon to use.
8221 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
8222 The syslog configuration file to use.
8227 @anchor{syslog-service}
8229 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
8230 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
8232 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
8233 information on the configuration file syntax.
8236 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
8237 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
8238 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
8239 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
8242 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
8243 The Guix package to use.
8245 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
8246 Name of the group for build user accounts.
8248 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
8249 Number of build user accounts to create.
8251 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
8252 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
8253 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
8254 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{hydra.gnu.org}
8255 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8257 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
8258 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @var{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
8259 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
8260 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
8261 contains that of @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8263 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
8264 Whether to use substitutes.
8266 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
8267 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
8269 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
8270 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
8272 @item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
8273 @itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
8274 The lsof and lsh packages to use.
8279 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
8280 Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
8284 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
8285 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
8288 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} urandom-seed-service @var{#f}
8289 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
8293 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
8294 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
8295 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
8296 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
8301 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{files} ...
8302 @cindex keyboard layout
8303 Return a service to load console keymaps from @var{files} using
8304 @command{loadkeys} command. Most likely, you want to load some default
8305 keymap, which can be done like this:
8308 (console-keymap-service "dvorak")
8311 Or, for example, for a Swedish keyboard, you may need to combine
8312 the following keymaps:
8314 (console-keymap-service "se-lat6" "se-fi-lat6")
8317 Also you can specify a full file name (or file names) of your keymap(s).
8318 See @code{man loadkeys} for details.
8324 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
8326 Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
8327 command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
8328 notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
8329 uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
8331 This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
8334 @anchor{guix-publish-service}
8335 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
8336 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
8337 Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
8338 and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
8340 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
8341 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
8342 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
8345 @anchor{rngd-service}
8346 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
8347 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
8348 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
8349 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
8350 @var{device} does not exist.
8353 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
8354 @cindex session limits
8357 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @var{limits}]
8359 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
8360 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
8361 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
8362 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
8363 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
8365 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
8366 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
8371 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
8372 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
8375 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
8376 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
8377 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
8378 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
8381 @node Scheduled Job Execution
8382 @subsubsection Scheduled Job Execution
8386 @cindex scheduling jobs
8387 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
8388 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
8389 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
8390 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
8391 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
8392 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
8394 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
8395 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
8396 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
8397 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
8398 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
8399 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
8400 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8403 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
8404 (use-package-modules base idutils)
8406 (define updatedb-job
8407 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
8408 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
8409 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
8411 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
8413 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
8415 (define garbage-collector-job
8416 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
8417 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
8418 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
8422 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
8423 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
8424 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
8425 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
8430 (services (cons (mcron-service (list garbage-collector-job
8436 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
8437 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
8438 reference of the mcron service.
8440 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mcron-service @var{jobs} [#:mcron @var{mcron2}]
8441 Return an mcron service running @var{mcron} that schedules @var{jobs}, a
8442 list of gexps denoting mcron job specifications.
8444 This is a shorthand for:
8446 (service mcron-service-type
8447 (mcron-configuration (mcron mcron) (jobs jobs)))
8451 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
8452 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
8453 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
8455 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
8456 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
8457 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
8461 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
8462 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
8465 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron2})
8466 The mcron package to use.
8469 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
8470 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
8471 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
8477 @subsubsection Log Rotation
8480 @cindex log rotation
8482 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
8483 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
8484 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
8485 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
8486 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
8488 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
8489 with the default settings.
8492 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
8493 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
8494 (use-package-modules base idutils)
8498 (services (cons* (mcron-service)
8499 (service rottlog-service-type (rottlog-configuration))
8503 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
8504 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
8505 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
8507 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
8508 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
8511 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
8512 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
8515 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
8516 The Rottlog package to use.
8518 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
8519 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
8520 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
8522 @item @code{periodic-rotations} (default: @code{`(("weekly" %default-rotatations))})
8523 A list of Rottlog period-name/period-config tuples.
8525 For example, taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period
8526 Related File Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a valid tuple
8530 ("daily" ,(plain-file "daily"
8532 /var/log/apache/* @{
8533 storedir apache-archives
8541 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
8542 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
8546 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
8547 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and
8548 @code{"/var/log/shepherd.log"}.
8551 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
8552 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
8553 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure")}.
8556 @node Networking Services
8557 @subsubsection Networking Services
8559 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
8560 the network interface.
8562 @cindex DHCP, networking service
8563 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
8564 Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
8565 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
8568 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
8569 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}]
8570 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
8571 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
8572 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway.
8578 @cindex network management
8579 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
8580 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
8581 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
8583 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
8584 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
8585 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
8586 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
8589 @cindex NetworkManager
8590 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
8591 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
8592 Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
8593 attempting to keep network connectivity active when available.
8597 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} connman-service @
8598 [#:connman @var{connman}]
8599 Return a service that runs @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman}, a network
8602 This service adds the @var{connman} package to the global profile, providing
8603 several the @command{connmanctl} command to interact with the daemon and
8604 configure networking."
8607 @cindex WPA Supplicant
8608 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
8609 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
8610 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
8611 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks. It is configured to listen for
8614 The value of this service is the @code{wpa-supplicant} package to use.
8615 Thus, it can be instantiated like this:
8618 (use-modules (gnu services networking)
8619 (gnu packages admin))
8621 (service wpa-supplicant-service-type wpa-supplicant)
8626 @cindex real time clock
8627 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
8628 [#:servers @var{%ntp-servers}] @
8629 [#:allow-large-adjustment? #f]
8630 Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
8631 @uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
8632 keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
8633 @var{allow-large-adjustment?} determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to
8634 make an initial adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
8637 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
8638 List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
8642 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
8643 Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
8646 The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
8647 @var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
8648 and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
8649 @command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
8652 @cindex hidden service
8653 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
8654 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
8655 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
8658 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
8659 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
8662 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
8663 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
8665 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
8666 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
8669 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
8670 project's documentation} for more information.
8673 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
8674 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
8675 [#:extra-settings ""]
8676 Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
8677 acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
8679 The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
8680 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
8681 local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
8682 come from any networking interface.
8684 In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
8688 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
8692 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
8693 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
8694 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
8695 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
8696 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
8697 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
8698 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
8699 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
8702 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
8703 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
8704 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
8705 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
8706 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
8708 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
8709 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
8710 require interaction.
8712 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
8713 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
8714 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
8715 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
8717 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
8718 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
8721 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
8722 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
8725 The other options should be self-descriptive.
8730 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
8731 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
8732 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
8733 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
8736 (service openssh-service-type
8737 (openssh-configuration
8738 (x11-forwarding? #t)
8739 (permit-root-login 'without-password)))
8742 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
8745 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
8746 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
8749 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
8750 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
8752 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
8753 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
8755 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
8756 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
8757 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
8758 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
8759 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
8761 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
8762 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
8765 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8766 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
8767 other authentication methods.
8769 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8770 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
8771 false, users have to use other authentication method.
8773 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
8774 This is used only by protocol version 2.
8776 @item @code{rsa-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8777 When true, users may log in using pure RSA authentication. When false,
8778 users have to use other means of authentication. This is used only by
8781 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
8782 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
8783 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
8784 @option{-Y} will work.
8786 @item @code{protocol-number} (default: @code{2})
8787 The SSH protocol number to use.
8791 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
8792 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
8793 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
8796 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
8797 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
8800 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
8801 (port-number 1234)))
8805 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
8806 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
8809 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
8810 The Dropbear package to use.
8812 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
8813 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
8815 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
8816 Whether to enable syslog output.
8818 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
8819 File name of the daemon's PID file.
8821 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
8822 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
8824 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
8825 Whether to allow empty passwords.
8827 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8828 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
8832 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
8833 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
8834 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
8835 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
8836 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
8837 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
8839 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
8840 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
8841 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
8844 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
8847 (host-name "mymachine")
8850 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
8851 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
8853 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
8854 %facebook-host-aliases))))
8857 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
8858 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
8861 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
8863 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
8864 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
8865 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
8866 [#:domains-to-browse '()] [#:debug? #f]
8867 Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
8868 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
8869 "zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
8870 extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
8871 @code{.local} host names using
8872 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
8873 add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
8874 @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
8876 If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
8877 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
8879 When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
8880 in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
8881 address via mDNS on the local network.
8883 When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
8885 Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
8891 @subsubsection X Window
8894 @cindex X Window System
8895 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
8896 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
8897 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
8898 started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
8900 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
8901 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
8904 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
8905 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
8908 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
8909 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
8911 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
8912 Command to run when halting.
8914 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
8915 Command to run when rebooting.
8917 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
8918 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
8920 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
8921 Directory to look for themes.
8923 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
8924 Directory to look for faces.
8926 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
8927 Default PATH to use.
8929 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default 1000)
8930 Minimum UID to display in SDDM.
8932 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default 2000)
8933 Maximum UID to display in SDDM
8935 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
8938 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
8939 Remember last session.
8941 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
8942 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
8944 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
8945 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
8947 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
8948 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
8950 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
8951 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
8953 @item @code{xorg-server-path} (default @code{xorg-start-command})
8954 Path to xorg-server.
8956 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
8959 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
8962 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
8963 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
8965 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
8966 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
8968 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitr })
8969 Script to run before starting a X session.
8971 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
8972 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
8974 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
8977 @item @code{xserver-arguments} (default "-nolisten tcp")
8978 Arguments to pass to xorg-server.
8980 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
8981 User to use for auto-login.
8983 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
8984 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
8986 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
8987 Relogin after logout.
8992 @cindex login manager
8993 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
8994 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
8995 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
8998 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
8999 (auto-login-user "Alice")
9000 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
9004 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
9005 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
9006 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
9007 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
9008 Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
9009 turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
9010 @code{xorg-start-command}.
9014 SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
9015 files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
9016 to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
9017 @var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
9018 adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
9019 available at the log-in screen.
9021 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
9022 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
9023 and/or other X clients.
9025 When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
9026 password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
9029 If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, use the default log-in theme; otherwise
9030 @var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
9031 theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
9035 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
9036 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
9037 The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
9040 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
9041 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
9042 Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
9043 from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
9044 file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
9045 @code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
9047 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
9050 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
9051 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
9052 Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
9053 all the common drivers.
9055 @var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
9056 graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
9057 this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
9059 Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
9060 appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
9061 resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
9063 Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
9064 @code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
9065 verbatim to the configuration file.
9068 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
9069 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
9070 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
9071 for it. For example:
9074 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
9077 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
9081 @node Printing Services
9082 @subsubsection Printing Services
9084 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
9085 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a GuixSD
9086 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
9088 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
9089 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
9090 CUPS configuration (see below). For example:
9092 (service cups-service-type (cups-configuration))
9096 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
9097 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
9098 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
9099 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
9100 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
9101 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
9102 secure connections to the print server.
9104 One way you might want to customize CUPS is to enable or disable the web
9105 interface. You can do that directly, like this:
9108 (service cups-service-type
9110 (web-interface? #f)))
9113 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
9114 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
9115 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
9116 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
9117 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
9118 from some other system; see the end for more details.
9120 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
9121 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
9122 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
9123 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
9124 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
9125 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
9126 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
9129 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
9131 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
9135 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
9136 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
9139 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
9140 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
9141 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
9143 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
9145 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
9146 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
9147 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
9148 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
9149 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
9150 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
9151 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
9152 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
9154 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
9157 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
9158 Where CUPS should cache data.
9160 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
9163 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
9164 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
9167 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
9168 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
9169 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
9170 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
9171 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
9173 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
9176 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
9177 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
9178 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
9179 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
9180 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
9181 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
9182 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
9183 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
9185 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
9188 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
9189 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
9194 No errors are fatal.
9197 All of the errors below are fatal.
9200 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
9201 to the DNS-SD daemon.
9204 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
9207 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
9208 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
9211 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
9214 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
9215 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
9218 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
9221 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
9222 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
9223 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
9225 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9228 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
9229 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
9232 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
9235 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
9236 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
9238 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
9241 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
9242 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
9243 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
9244 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
9245 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
9246 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
9247 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
9248 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
9250 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
9253 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
9254 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
9255 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
9257 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
9260 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
9261 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
9264 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
9267 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
9268 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
9269 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
9270 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
9271 used/supported on macOS.
9273 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
9276 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
9277 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
9278 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
9279 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
9280 PEM-encoded private keys.
9282 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
9285 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
9286 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
9288 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
9291 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
9292 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
9293 configuration or state files.
9295 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9298 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
9299 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
9302 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
9303 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
9305 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
9308 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
9309 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
9312 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
9316 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
9317 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
9318 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
9319 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
9320 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
9321 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
9322 level logs all requests.
9324 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
9327 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
9328 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
9329 longer required for quotas.
9331 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9334 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
9335 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
9337 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
9340 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
9341 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
9343 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9346 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
9347 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
9349 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9352 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
9353 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
9354 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
9355 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
9356 secure printing functions.
9358 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9361 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
9362 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
9363 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
9365 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9368 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
9369 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
9371 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
9374 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
9375 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
9377 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
9380 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
9381 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
9383 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
9386 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
9387 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
9388 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
9389 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
9390 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
9392 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
9395 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
9396 Specifies the default access policy to use.
9398 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
9401 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
9402 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
9404 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9407 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
9408 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
9409 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
9410 typically within a few milliseconds.
9412 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9415 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
9416 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
9417 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
9418 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
9419 @code{retry-this-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
9420 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
9422 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
9425 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
9426 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
9427 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
9428 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
9429 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
9430 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
9431 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
9434 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9437 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
9438 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
9439 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
9442 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9445 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
9446 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
9447 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
9448 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
9449 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
9450 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
9451 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
9453 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9456 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
9457 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
9458 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
9460 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9463 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
9464 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
9465 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
9466 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
9467 @code{retry-current-job}.
9469 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9472 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
9473 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
9474 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
9475 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
9476 @code{retry-current-job}.
9478 Defaults to @samp{5}.
9481 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
9482 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
9484 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9487 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
9488 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
9490 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9493 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
9494 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
9495 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
9497 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9500 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
9501 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
9502 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
9503 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
9504 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
9505 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
9506 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
9509 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
9510 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
9511 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
9512 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
9513 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
9514 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
9517 Defaults to @samp{128}.
9520 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
9521 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
9523 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
9525 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
9526 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
9529 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
9530 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
9531 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
9533 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9536 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
9537 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
9539 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9541 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
9543 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
9544 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
9545 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
9547 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9550 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
9551 Methods to which this access control applies.
9553 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9556 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
9557 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
9558 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
9560 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9565 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
9566 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
9567 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
9568 of the LogLevel setting.
9570 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9573 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
9574 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
9575 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
9577 Defaults to @samp{info}.
9580 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
9581 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
9582 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
9584 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
9587 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
9588 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
9591 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9594 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
9595 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
9596 from a single address.
9598 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9601 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
9602 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
9605 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
9608 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
9609 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
9610 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
9613 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9616 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
9617 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
9618 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
9620 Defaults to @samp{500}.
9623 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
9624 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
9625 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
9627 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9630 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
9631 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
9632 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
9634 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9637 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
9638 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
9639 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
9641 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
9644 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
9645 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
9646 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
9648 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
9651 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
9652 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
9653 multiple file print job, in seconds.
9655 Defaults to @samp{300}.
9658 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
9659 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
9660 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
9661 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
9662 sequences are recognized:
9666 insert a single percent character
9669 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
9672 insert the number of copies for the current page
9675 insert the current page number
9678 insert the current date and time in common log format
9684 insert the printer name
9690 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
9691 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
9692 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
9695 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9698 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
9699 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
9702 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9705 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
9706 Specifies named access control policies.
9708 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
9710 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
9714 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
9715 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
9716 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
9717 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
9718 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
9719 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
9720 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
9721 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
9722 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
9723 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
9725 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
9728 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
9729 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
9730 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
9732 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
9733 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
9736 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
9737 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
9738 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
9739 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
9740 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
9741 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
9742 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
9743 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
9744 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
9745 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
9747 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
9750 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
9751 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
9752 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
9754 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
9755 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
9758 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
9759 Access control by IPP operation.
9761 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9765 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
9766 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
9767 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
9768 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
9769 value applies indefinitely.
9771 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
9774 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
9775 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
9776 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
9777 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
9778 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
9780 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9783 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
9784 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
9785 restarting the scheduler.
9787 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9790 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
9791 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
9792 into bitmaps for a printer.
9794 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
9797 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
9798 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
9800 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
9803 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
9804 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
9805 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
9806 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
9807 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
9808 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
9809 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
9812 Defaults to @samp{*}.
9815 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
9816 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
9818 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
9821 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
9822 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
9823 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
9824 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
9825 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
9826 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
9827 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
9828 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
9830 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
9833 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string set-env
9834 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
9836 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
9839 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
9840 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
9841 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
9842 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
9843 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
9845 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9848 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
9849 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
9850 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. The
9851 @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher suites, which are
9852 required for some older clients that do not implement newer ones. The
9853 @code{AllowSSL3} option enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some
9854 older clients that do not support TLS v1.0.
9856 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9859 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
9860 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
9861 the IPP specifications.
9863 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9866 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
9867 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
9869 Defaults to @samp{300}.
9873 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
9874 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
9876 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9879 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
9880 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
9881 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
9882 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
9883 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
9884 @code{cups-service-type}.
9886 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
9888 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
9892 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
9893 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
9896 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
9897 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
9900 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
9901 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
9905 (service cups-service-type
9906 (opaque-cups-configuration
9907 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
9908 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
9912 @node Desktop Services
9913 @subsubsection Desktop Services
9915 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
9916 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
9917 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
9918 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
9919 environments like GNOME and XFCE.
9921 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
9922 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
9923 environment and networking:
9925 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
9926 This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
9927 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
9929 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
9930 @code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
9931 a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
9932 Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
9933 the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
9934 the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
9935 Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
9936 configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
9940 The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
9941 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
9942 Reference, @code{services}}).
9944 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service} and
9945 @code{xfce-desktop-service} procedures can add GNOME and/or XFCE to a
9946 system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the
9947 backlight adjustment helpers and the power management utilities are
9948 added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
9949 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
9950 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
9951 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service} adds the GNOME
9952 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the XFCE service
9953 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
9954 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
9955 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
9956 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
9958 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gnome-desktop-service
9959 Return a service that adds the @code{gnome} package to the system
9960 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
9961 @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
9964 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xfce-desktop-service
9965 Return a service that adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile,
9966 and extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the
9967 file system as root from within a user session, after the user has
9968 authenticated with the administrator's password.
9971 Because the GNOME and XFCE desktop services pull in so many packages,
9972 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include either of
9973 them by default. To add GNOME or XFCE, just @code{cons} them onto
9974 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
9975 @code{operating-system}:
9979 (use-service-modules desktop)
9982 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
9983 (services (cons* (gnome-desktop-service)
9984 (xfce-desktop-service)
9989 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
9990 graphical login window.
9992 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
9993 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
9994 are described below.
9996 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
9997 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
9998 support for @var{services}.
10000 @uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
10001 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
10002 and to be notified of system-wide events.
10004 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
10005 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
10006 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
10007 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
10010 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
10011 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
10012 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
10013 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
10014 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
10015 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
10017 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
10018 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
10019 when the power button is pressed.
10021 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
10022 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
10023 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
10024 their default values are:
10027 @item kill-user-processes?
10029 @item kill-only-users
10031 @item kill-exclude-users
10033 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
10035 @item handle-power-key
10037 @item handle-suspend-key
10039 @item handle-hibernate-key
10041 @item handle-lid-switch
10043 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
10045 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
10047 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
10049 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
10051 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
10053 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
10057 @item idle-action-seconds
10059 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
10061 @item runtime-directory-size
10065 @item suspend-state
10066 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
10069 @item hibernate-state
10071 @item hibernate-mode
10072 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
10073 @item hybrid-sleep-state
10075 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
10076 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
10080 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
10081 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
10082 Return a service that runs the
10083 @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
10084 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
10085 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
10086 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
10087 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
10088 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
10091 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
10092 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
10093 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
10094 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
10095 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
10096 [#:percentage-low 10] @
10097 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
10098 [#:percentage-action 2] @
10099 [#:time-low 1200] @
10100 [#:time-critical 300] @
10101 [#:time-action 120] @
10102 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
10103 Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
10104 @command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
10105 levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
10106 @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
10110 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
10111 Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
10112 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
10113 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
10114 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
10117 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
10118 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
10119 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
10120 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
10121 tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
10122 site} for more information.
10125 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
10126 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
10127 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
10128 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
10129 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
10130 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
10131 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
10132 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
10133 means that all users are allowed.
10136 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
10137 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
10138 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
10139 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
10140 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
10141 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
10142 know the user's location.
10145 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
10146 [#:whitelist '()] @
10147 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
10148 [#:submit-data? #f]
10149 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
10150 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
10151 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
10152 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
10153 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
10154 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
10155 location databases. See
10156 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
10157 web site} for more information.
10160 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}]
10161 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which manages
10162 all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus interfaces.
10164 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
10167 @node Database Services
10168 @subsubsection Database Services
10172 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
10174 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
10175 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
10176 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8'']
10177 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
10180 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
10181 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
10182 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
10185 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
10186 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
10189 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
10190 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
10193 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
10194 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
10197 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
10198 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
10201 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
10202 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
10204 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
10205 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
10209 @node Mail Services
10210 @subsubsection Mail Services
10214 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
10215 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
10216 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
10217 in the subsections below.
10219 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
10221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
10222 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
10225 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
10226 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
10227 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
10228 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
10229 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
10230 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
10231 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
10232 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
10234 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
10235 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
10238 (dovecot-service #:config
10239 (dovecot-configuration
10240 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
10243 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
10244 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
10245 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
10246 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
10247 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
10248 from some other system; see the end for more details.
10250 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
10251 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
10252 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
10253 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
10254 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
10255 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
10256 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
10258 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
10260 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
10261 The dovecot package.
10264 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
10265 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
10266 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
10267 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
10268 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
10269 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
10272 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
10273 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
10274 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
10276 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
10278 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
10279 The name of the protocol.
10282 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
10283 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
10284 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
10285 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
10288 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
10289 Space separated list of plugins to load.
10292 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
10293 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
10294 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
10295 Defaults to @samp{10}.
10300 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
10301 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
10302 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
10305 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
10307 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
10308 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
10309 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
10310 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
10311 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
10314 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
10315 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
10316 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
10317 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
10318 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10320 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
10322 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
10323 The file name on which to listen.
10326 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
10327 The access mode for the socket.
10328 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
10331 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
10332 The user to own the socket.
10333 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10336 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
10337 The group to own the socket.
10338 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10342 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
10344 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
10345 The file name on which to listen.
10348 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
10349 The access mode for the socket.
10350 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
10353 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
10354 The user to own the socket.
10355 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10358 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
10359 The group to own the socket.
10360 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10364 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
10366 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
10367 The protocol to listen for.
10370 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
10371 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
10372 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10375 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
10376 The port on which to listen.
10379 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
10380 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
10382 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10387 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
10388 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
10389 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
10390 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
10391 Defaults to @samp{1}.
10394 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
10395 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
10396 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10399 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
10400 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
10402 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
10407 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
10408 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
10411 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
10413 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
10414 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
10415 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10420 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
10421 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
10422 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
10424 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
10426 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
10427 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
10428 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
10430 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
10433 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
10434 A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
10435 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10440 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
10441 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
10442 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
10444 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
10446 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
10447 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
10448 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
10449 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
10452 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
10453 A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
10454 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10457 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
10458 Override fields from passwd.
10459 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10464 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
10465 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
10469 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
10470 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
10471 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
10473 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
10475 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
10476 Name for this namespace.
10479 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
10480 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
10481 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
10484 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
10485 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
10486 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
10487 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
10489 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10492 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
10493 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
10494 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
10495 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10498 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
10499 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
10500 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
10501 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10504 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
10505 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
10507 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10510 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
10511 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
10512 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
10513 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
10514 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
10515 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
10517 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10520 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
10521 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
10522 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
10523 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
10524 hides the namespace prefix.
10525 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10528 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
10529 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
10530 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
10532 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10535 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
10536 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
10537 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10539 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
10541 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
10542 Name for this mailbox.
10545 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
10546 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
10547 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
10548 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
10551 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
10552 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
10553 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
10554 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
10555 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10562 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
10563 Base directory where to store runtime data.
10564 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
10567 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
10568 Greeting message for clients.
10569 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
10572 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
10573 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
10574 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
10575 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
10576 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
10578 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10581 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
10582 List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
10583 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10586 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
10587 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
10588 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
10589 processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
10591 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10594 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
10595 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
10596 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
10597 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
10598 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. due to a security fix).
10599 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10602 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
10603 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
10604 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
10605 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10608 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
10609 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
10610 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
10613 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
10614 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
10615 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
10616 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
10619 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
10620 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
10621 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
10622 matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
10623 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
10624 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
10625 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10628 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
10629 Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
10630 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
10631 for caching to be used.
10632 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10635 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
10636 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
10637 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
10638 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
10639 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
10640 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
10642 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
10645 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
10646 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
10647 0 disables caching them completely.
10648 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
10651 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
10652 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
10653 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
10654 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
10656 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10659 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
10660 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
10661 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
10663 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10666 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
10667 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
10668 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
10669 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
10670 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
10671 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
10672 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
10675 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
10676 Username character translations before it's looked up from
10677 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
10678 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
10679 translated to @samp{@@}.
10680 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10683 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
10684 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
10685 use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
10686 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
10687 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
10688 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
10689 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
10692 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
10693 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
10694 username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
10695 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
10696 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
10697 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
10699 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10702 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
10703 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
10705 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
10708 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
10709 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
10710 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
10711 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
10712 Defaults to @samp{30}.
10715 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
10716 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
10717 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
10718 allow all keytab entries.
10719 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10722 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
10723 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
10724 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
10725 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
10727 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10730 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
10731 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
10732 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
10733 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
10734 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10737 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
10738 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
10739 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
10742 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
10743 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
10744 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
10747 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
10748 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
10750 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10753 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
10754 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
10755 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
10757 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10760 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
10761 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
10762 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
10763 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
10764 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
10765 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
10768 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
10769 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
10770 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
10771 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
10772 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10775 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
10776 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
10777 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
10778 Defaults to @samp{()}.
10781 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
10782 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
10783 has any connections.
10784 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
10787 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
10788 TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
10789 connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
10790 @samp{inet-listener} for the port.
10791 Defaults to @samp{0}.
10794 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
10795 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
10796 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
10797 are shared within domain.
10798 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
10801 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
10802 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
10803 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
10804 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
10807 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
10808 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
10810 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10813 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
10814 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
10815 @samp{info-log-path}.
10816 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10819 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
10820 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
10821 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
10822 standard facilities are supported.
10823 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
10826 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
10827 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
10829 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10832 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
10833 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
10834 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
10835 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
10836 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
10837 ":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
10838 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10841 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
10842 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
10844 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10847 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
10848 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
10849 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
10851 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10854 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
10855 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
10856 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
10857 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10860 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
10861 Show protocol level SSL errors.
10862 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10865 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
10866 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
10867 strftime(3) format.
10868 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
10871 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
10872 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
10873 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
10877 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
10878 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
10879 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
10880 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
10883 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
10884 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
10885 of possible variables you can use.
10886 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
10889 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
10890 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
10893 Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
10905 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
10908 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
10909 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
10910 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
10911 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
10912 Dovecot the full location.
10914 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
10915 file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
10916 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
10917 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
10918 @samp{mail-location} setting.
10920 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
10926 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
10928 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
10933 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
10935 @item maildir:~/Maildir
10936 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
10937 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
10939 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10942 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
10943 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
10944 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
10945 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
10946 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10949 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
10951 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10954 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
10955 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
10956 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
10957 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
10959 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10962 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
10963 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
10964 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
10965 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
10966 symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
10967 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
10968 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
10969 Defaults to @samp{""}.
10972 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
10973 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
10974 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
10975 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
10976 names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
10977 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10980 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
10981 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
10982 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
10983 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
10986 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
10987 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
10988 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
10989 nowadays by default.
10990 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
10993 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
10994 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
10997 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
10999 Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
11001 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
11003 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
11006 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
11007 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
11008 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
11010 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11013 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
11014 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
11015 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
11016 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11019 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
11020 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
11021 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
11022 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
11023 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
11024 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
11027 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
11028 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
11030 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
11033 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
11034 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
11035 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
11036 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
11038 Defaults to @samp{500}.
11041 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
11043 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11046 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
11047 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
11048 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
11049 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
11050 Defaults to @samp{1}.
11053 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
11055 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11058 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
11059 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
11060 trying to create new keywords.
11061 Defaults to @samp{50}.
11064 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
11065 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
11066 processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
11067 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
11068 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
11069 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
11070 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
11071 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
11072 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
11073 Defaults to @samp{()}.
11076 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
11077 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
11078 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
11079 directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
11080 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
11081 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
11082 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
11083 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
11084 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11087 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
11088 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
11089 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
11090 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
11093 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
11094 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
11095 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
11098 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
11099 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
11100 LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
11101 Defaults to @samp{()}.
11104 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
11105 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
11106 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
11107 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
11108 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11111 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
11112 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
11113 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
11114 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
11115 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
11117 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
11120 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
11121 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
11122 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
11123 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
11124 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
11125 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
11126 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11129 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
11130 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
11131 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
11132 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
11133 causes more disk I/O.
11134 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
11135 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
11136 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11139 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
11140 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
11141 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
11143 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11146 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
11147 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
11148 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
11149 the mail otherwise.
11150 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11153 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
11154 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
11159 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
11160 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
11161 need write access to that directory.
11163 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
11164 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
11166 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
11168 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
11170 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
11173 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
11174 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
11175 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
11176 them simultaneously.
11179 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
11183 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
11184 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
11185 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
11188 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
11189 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
11190 override the lock file after this much time.
11191 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
11194 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
11195 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
11196 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
11197 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
11198 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
11199 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
11200 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
11201 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
11202 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
11203 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
11204 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11207 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
11208 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
11209 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
11210 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
11211 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11214 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
11215 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
11216 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
11217 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
11218 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
11219 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11222 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
11223 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
11224 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
11226 Defaults to @samp{0}.
11229 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
11230 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
11231 Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
11234 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
11235 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
11236 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
11238 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
11241 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
11242 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
11243 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
11244 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
11245 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11248 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
11249 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
11250 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
11251 don't support this for now.
11253 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
11255 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
11256 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11259 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
11260 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
11261 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
11263 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
11266 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
11267 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
11270 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
11272 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
11273 @item sis-queue posix
11274 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
11276 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
11279 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
11280 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
11281 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
11282 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
11283 truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
11284 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
11287 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
11289 Defaults to @samp{100}.
11292 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
11294 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
11297 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
11298 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
11299 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
11300 before they eat up everything.
11301 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
11304 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
11305 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
11306 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
11308 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
11311 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
11312 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
11313 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
11315 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
11318 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
11319 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
11320 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
11323 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
11324 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
11325 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
11328 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
11329 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
11330 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
11332 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
11335 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
11336 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
11337 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
11338 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
11339 instead to a different.
11340 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11343 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
11344 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
11345 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
11346 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
11347 CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
11348 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11351 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
11352 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
11353 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
11356 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
11357 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
11358 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
11359 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11362 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
11363 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
11364 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
11365 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
11366 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
11369 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
11370 How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
11371 quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
11372 regeneration entirely.
11373 Defaults to @samp{168}.
11376 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
11377 SSL protocols to use.
11378 Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
11381 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
11382 SSL ciphers to use.
11383 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
11386 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
11387 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
11388 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11391 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
11392 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
11393 %d expands to recipient domain.
11394 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
11397 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
11398 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
11399 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
11400 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11403 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
11404 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
11406 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11409 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
11410 Binary to use for sending mails.
11411 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
11414 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
11415 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
11417 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11420 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
11421 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
11422 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
11423 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
11426 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
11427 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
11440 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
11443 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
11444 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
11446 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
11449 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
11450 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
11451 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
11452 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
11454 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11457 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
11458 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
11460 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11463 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
11464 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
11466 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
11469 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
11470 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
11471 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
11472 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
11474 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
11477 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
11478 IMAP logout format string:
11481 total number of bytes read from client
11483 total number of bytes sent to client.
11485 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
11488 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
11489 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
11490 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
11491 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11494 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
11495 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
11497 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
11500 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
11501 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
11502 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
11503 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
11505 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11508 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
11509 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
11510 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11513 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
11514 Workarounds for various client bugs:
11517 @item delay-newmail
11518 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
11519 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
11520 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
11521 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
11522 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
11525 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
11526 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
11527 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
11528 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
11530 @item tb-lsub-flags
11531 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
11532 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
11533 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
11535 Defaults to @samp{()}.
11538 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
11539 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
11540 Defaults to @samp{""}.
11544 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
11545 that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
11546 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
11547 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
11548 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
11550 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
11551 and running. In that case, you can pass an
11552 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
11553 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
11554 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
11556 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
11558 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
11559 The dovecot package.
11562 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
11563 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
11566 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
11567 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
11570 (dovecot-service #:config
11571 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
11575 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
11577 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
11578 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
11579 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
11580 as in this example:
11583 (service opensmtpd-service-type
11584 (opensmtpd-configuration
11585 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
11589 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
11590 Data type regresenting the configuration of opensmtpd.
11593 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
11594 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
11596 @item @code{config-file} (default: @var{%default-opensmtpd-file})
11597 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
11598 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
11599 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
11600 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
11605 @node Kerberos Services
11606 @subsubsection Kerberos Services
11609 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
11610 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
11612 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
11614 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
11615 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
11616 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
11617 operating system declaration.
11618 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
11620 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
11621 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
11622 Other implementations have not been tested.
11624 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
11625 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
11629 Here is an example of its use:
11631 (service krb5-service-type
11632 (krb5-configuration
11633 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
11634 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
11637 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
11638 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
11639 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
11642 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
11643 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
11647 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
11649 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
11650 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
11651 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
11652 specified by clients;
11653 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
11656 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
11657 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
11658 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
11659 @uref{http://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
11663 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
11664 @cindex realm, kerberos
11667 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
11668 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
11669 converted to upper case.
11671 @item @code{admin-server}
11672 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
11676 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
11681 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
11684 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
11685 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
11686 known to be weak will be accepted.
11688 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
11689 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
11690 realm for the client.
11691 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
11692 If this value is @code{#f}
11693 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
11694 such as @command{kinit}.
11696 @item @code{realms}
11697 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
11699 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
11705 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
11708 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
11709 management via Kerberos.
11710 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
11711 users using Kerberos.
11713 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
11714 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
11717 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
11718 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module
11719 This type has the following parameters:
11721 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
11722 The pam-krb5 package to use.
11724 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
11725 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
11726 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
11732 @subsubsection Web Services
11737 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
11739 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
11740 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
11741 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
11742 [#:vhost-list (list (nginx-vhost-configuration))] @
11745 Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
11747 The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
11748 Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
11749 files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
11750 arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
11751 directories are created when the service is activated.
11753 As an alternative to using a @var{config-file}, @var{vhost-list} can be
11754 used to specify the list of @dfn{virtual hosts} required on the host. For
11755 this to work, use the default value for @var{config-file}.
11759 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-vhost-configuration
11760 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx virtual host.
11761 This type has the following parameters:
11764 @item @code{http-port} (default: @code{80})
11765 Nginx will listen for HTTP connection on this port. Set it at @code{#f} if
11766 nginx should not listen for HTTP (non secure) connection for this
11767 @dfn{virtual host}.
11769 @item @code{https-port} (default: @code{443})
11770 Nginx will listen for HTTPS connection on this port. Set it at @code{#f} if
11771 nginx should not listen for HTTPS (secure) connection for this @dfn{virtual host}.
11773 Note that nginx can listen for HTTP and HTTPS connections in the same
11774 @dfn{virtual host}.
11776 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
11777 A list of server names this vhost represents. @code{'default} represents the
11778 default vhost for connections matching no other vhost.
11780 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
11781 Root of the website nginx will serve.
11783 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
11784 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
11785 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
11787 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{"/etc/nginx/cert.pem"})
11788 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
11789 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
11791 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{"/etc/nginx/key.pem"})
11792 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
11793 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
11795 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
11796 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
11801 @node Network File System
11802 @subsubsection Network File System
11805 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
11806 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
11807 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
11809 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
11812 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
11813 universal addresses.
11814 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
11815 started when a dependent service starts.
11817 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
11818 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
11822 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
11823 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
11824 This type has the following parameters:
11826 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
11827 The rpcbind package to use.
11829 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
11830 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
11831 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
11837 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
11841 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
11842 between the kernel and user space programs.
11844 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
11845 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
11848 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
11849 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
11850 This type has the following parameters:
11852 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
11853 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
11858 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
11861 @cindex global security system
11863 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
11865 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
11866 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
11867 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
11869 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
11870 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
11873 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
11874 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
11875 This type has the following parameters:
11877 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
11878 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
11880 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
11881 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
11887 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
11889 @cindex name mapper
11891 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
11892 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
11894 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
11895 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
11898 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
11899 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
11900 This type has the following parameters:
11902 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
11903 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
11905 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
11906 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
11908 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
11909 The local NFSv4 domain name.
11910 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
11911 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
11916 @node Continuous Integration
11917 @subsubsection Continuous Integration
11919 @cindex continuous integration
11920 @uref{https://notabug.org/mthl/cuirass, Cuirass} is a continuous
11921 integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and for
11922 providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
11924 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
11926 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service @
11927 [#:config @code{(cuirass-configuration)}]
11928 Return a service that runs @command{cuirass}.
11930 The @var{#:config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
11931 @command{cuirass}, which must be a @code{<cuirass-configuration>}
11932 object, by default it doesn't provide any build job. If you want to
11933 provide your own configuration you will most likely use the
11934 @code{cuirass-configuration} special form which returns such objects.
11937 In order to add build jobs you will have to set the
11938 @code{specifications} field. Here is an example of a cuirass service
11939 defining a build job based on a specification that can be found in
11940 Cuirass source tree.
11943 (let ((spec `((#:name . "guix")
11944 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
11945 (#:load-path . ".")
11946 ;; Adapt to a valid absolute file name.
11947 (#:file . "/.../cuirass/tests/gnu-system.scm")
11948 (#:proc . hydra-jobs)
11949 (#:arguments (subset . "hello"))
11950 (#:branch . "master"))))
11951 (cuirass-service #:config (cuirass-configuration
11952 (specifications (list spec)))))
11955 While information related to build jobs are located directly in the
11956 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
11957 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
11959 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
11960 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
11963 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{""})
11964 Location of the repository cache.
11966 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
11967 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
11969 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
11970 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
11972 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
11973 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
11976 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/run/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
11977 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
11978 added specifications.
11980 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{'()})
11981 A list of specifications, where a specification is an association list
11982 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
11983 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
11986 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
11987 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
11990 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
11991 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
11995 @node Miscellaneous Services
11996 @subsubsection Miscellaneous Services
12000 @subsubheading Lirc Service
12002 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
12004 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
12005 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
12006 [#:extra-options '()]
12007 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
12008 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
12010 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
12011 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
12014 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
12015 passed to @command{lircd}.
12019 @subsubheading Spice Service
12021 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
12023 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
12024 Returns a service that runs @url{http://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
12025 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
12026 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
12029 @subsubsection Dictionary Services
12031 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
12033 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
12034 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
12035 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12037 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
12038 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
12039 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
12041 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
12042 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
12043 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12046 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
12047 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
12050 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
12051 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
12053 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
12054 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
12055 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
12056 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12058 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
12059 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
12063 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
12064 Data type representing a dictionary database.
12068 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
12070 @item @code{module}
12071 Name of the dicod module used by this database
12072 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12074 @item @code{options}
12075 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
12076 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
12080 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
12081 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
12082 Dictonary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
12085 @subsubsection Version Control
12087 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides the following services:
12089 @subsubheading Git daemon service
12091 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
12093 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
12094 expose repositiories over the Git protocol for annoymous access.
12096 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
12097 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
12098 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
12099 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
12104 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
12105 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
12108 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
12109 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
12111 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
12112 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
12113 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
12115 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
12116 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
12117 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
12118 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
12119 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
12121 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
12122 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
12123 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
12124 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
12125 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
12126 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
12127 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
12129 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
12130 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
12133 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
12134 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
12136 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
12137 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
12139 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
12140 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
12141 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
12146 @node Setuid Programs
12147 @subsection Setuid Programs
12149 @cindex setuid programs
12150 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
12151 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
12152 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
12153 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
12154 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
12155 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
12156 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
12157 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
12158 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
12160 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
12161 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
12162 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
12163 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
12164 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
12165 should be setuid root.
12167 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
12168 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
12169 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
12170 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
12171 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
12174 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
12177 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
12178 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
12180 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
12181 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
12183 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
12184 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
12187 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
12188 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
12189 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
12192 @node X.509 Certificates
12193 @subsection X.509 Certificates
12195 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
12196 @cindex X.509 certificates
12198 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
12199 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
12200 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
12201 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
12202 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
12203 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
12205 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
12206 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
12209 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
12210 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
12211 certificates can be found.
12213 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
12214 In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
12215 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
12216 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
12217 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
12218 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
12220 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
12221 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
12222 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
12223 to the certificates installed globally.
12225 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
12226 can also install their own certificate package in
12227 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
12228 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
12229 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
12230 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
12231 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
12232 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
12233 would typically run something like:
12236 $ guix package -i nss-certs
12237 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
12238 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
12239 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
12242 @node Name Service Switch
12243 @subsection Name Service Switch
12245 @cindex name service switch
12247 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
12248 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
12249 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
12250 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
12251 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
12252 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
12253 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
12254 C Library Reference Manual}).
12256 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
12257 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
12258 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
12259 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
12260 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
12261 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
12264 @cindex .local, host name lookup
12265 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
12266 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
12267 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
12268 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
12271 (name-service-switch
12272 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
12274 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
12275 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
12277 (name "mdns_minimal")
12279 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
12280 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
12281 ;; no need to try the next methods.
12282 (reaction (lookup-specification
12283 (not-found => return))))
12285 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
12289 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
12294 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
12295 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
12296 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
12298 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
12299 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
12300 you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
12301 @code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
12302 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
12303 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
12304 @code{nscd-service}}).
12306 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
12309 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
12310 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
12311 @code{name-service-switch} object.
12314 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
12315 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
12316 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
12319 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
12320 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
12321 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
12322 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12323 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
12324 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
12325 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
12326 run @command{guix system}.
12328 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
12330 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
12331 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
12348 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
12349 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
12353 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
12355 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
12356 associated lookup action.
12360 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
12361 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12363 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
12364 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
12365 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
12366 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
12369 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
12370 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
12371 Reference Manual}). For example:
12374 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
12375 (success => return))
12380 @node Initial RAM Disk
12381 @subsection Initial RAM Disk
12384 @cindex initial RAM disk
12385 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
12386 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
12387 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
12388 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
12389 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
12391 The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
12392 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
12393 system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
12394 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
12395 @code{expression->initrd} procedure.
12397 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
12398 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
12399 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
12400 system declaration like this:
12403 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
12404 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
12405 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
12406 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
12407 (apply base-initrd file-systems
12408 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
12412 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
12413 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
12414 volatile root file system.
12416 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
12417 options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
12418 passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
12419 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
12422 @item --load=@var{boot}
12423 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
12424 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
12426 GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
12427 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
12428 initialization system.
12430 @item --root=@var{root}
12431 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
12432 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
12435 @item --system=@var{system}
12436 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
12439 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
12440 @cindex module, black-listing
12441 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
12442 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
12443 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
12444 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
12445 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
12448 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
12449 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
12450 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
12451 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
12452 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
12456 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
12457 @code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
12461 @cindex initial RAM disk
12462 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
12463 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
12464 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
12465 Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
12466 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
12467 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
12468 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
12469 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
12471 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
12472 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
12473 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
12475 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
12478 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
12479 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
12480 modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
12481 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
12484 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
12485 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
12486 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
12487 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
12488 program to run in that initrd.
12490 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
12491 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
12492 Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
12493 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
12494 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
12495 automatically copied to the initrd.
12498 @node GRUB Configuration
12499 @subsection GRUB Configuration
12502 @cindex boot loader
12504 The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
12505 (@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
12506 configured using a @code{grub-configuration} declaration. This data type
12507 is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module and described below.
12509 @deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
12510 The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
12514 @item @code{device}
12515 This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
12516 understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
12517 @code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
12520 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
12521 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
12522 entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
12523 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
12525 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
12526 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
12529 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
12530 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
12531 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
12533 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
12534 The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
12541 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
12542 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
12543 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
12544 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
12549 (label "The Other Distro")
12550 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
12551 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
12552 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
12557 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
12558 The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
12563 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
12566 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
12569 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
12572 It is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the file path
12573 using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming convention,,, grub,
12574 GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
12577 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
12580 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
12581 field is ignored entirely.
12583 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
12584 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
12585 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
12587 @item @code{initrd}
12588 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
12589 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12591 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
12592 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., the GRUB
12593 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
12595 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
12596 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case GRUB will
12597 search the device containing the file specified by the @code{linux}
12598 field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It must @emph{not} be
12599 an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
12601 @item @code{device-mount-point} (default: @code{"/"})
12602 The mount point of the above device on the system. You probably do not
12603 need to change the default value. GuixSD uses it to strip the prefix of
12604 store file names for systems where @file{/gnu} or @file{/gnu/store} is
12605 on a separate partition.
12610 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
12611 Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
12614 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
12615 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
12616 fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
12620 @node Invoking guix system
12621 @subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
12623 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
12624 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
12625 system} command. The synopsis is:
12628 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
12631 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
12632 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
12633 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
12638 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
12639 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
12640 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
12641 systems already running GuixSD.}.
12643 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
12644 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
12645 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
12646 currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
12647 attempt to upgrade it since this would not be possible without stopping it
12650 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
12651 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
12652 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
12653 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
12654 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
12656 It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
12657 entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
12658 @option{--no-grub} is passed.
12661 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
12662 @c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
12663 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
12664 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
12665 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
12666 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
12669 @item switch-generation
12670 @cindex generations
12671 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
12672 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It also
12673 rearranges the system's existing GRUB menu entries. It makes the menu
12674 entry for the specified system generation the default, and it moves the
12675 entries for the other generations to a submenu. The next time the
12676 system boots, it will use the specified system generation.
12678 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
12679 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
12683 guix system switch-generation 7
12686 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
12687 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
12688 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
12689 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
12690 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
12691 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
12694 guix system switch-generation -- -1
12697 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
12698 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the GRUB menu
12699 entries. To actually start using the target system generation, you must
12700 reboot after running this action. In the future, it will be updated to
12701 do the same things as @command{reconfigure}, like activating and
12702 deactivating services.
12704 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
12707 @cindex rolling back
12708 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
12709 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
12710 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
12711 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
12713 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
12714 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
12718 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
12719 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
12720 This action does not actually install anything.
12723 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
12724 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
12725 installations of GuixSD. For instance:
12728 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
12731 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
12732 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
12733 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
12734 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
12735 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
12737 This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
12738 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
12741 @cindex virtual machine
12743 @anchor{guix system vm}
12744 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
12745 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
12746 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU.
12748 The VM shares its store with the host system.
12750 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
12751 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
12752 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
12753 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
12755 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
12756 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
12757 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
12760 guix system vm my-config.scm \
12761 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
12764 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
12765 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
12766 store of the host can then be mounted.
12768 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
12769 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
12770 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
12771 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
12776 Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
12777 in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
12778 to specify the size of the image.
12780 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
12781 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
12782 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
12784 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
12785 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
12786 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
12787 using the following command:
12790 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
12794 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
12795 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
12796 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
12797 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
12798 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
12799 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
12801 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
12802 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
12805 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
12806 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
12807 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
12810 guix system container my-config.scm \
12811 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
12815 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
12820 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
12821 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
12825 @item --system=@var{system}
12826 @itemx -s @var{system}
12827 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
12828 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
12832 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
12835 @item --image-size=@var{size}
12836 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
12837 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
12838 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
12839 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
12841 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
12842 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
12843 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
12846 @item nothing-special
12847 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
12850 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
12853 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
12854 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
12855 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
12856 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
12857 a list of available debugging commands.
12862 All the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
12863 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
12864 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
12865 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
12866 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
12867 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
12870 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
12871 your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
12872 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
12877 @item list-generations
12878 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
12879 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
12880 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
12881 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
12883 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
12884 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
12885 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
12886 generations that are up to 10 days old:
12889 $ guix system list-generations 10d
12894 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
12895 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
12898 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
12901 @item extension-graph
12902 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
12903 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
12904 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
12910 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
12913 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
12915 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
12916 @item shepherd-graph
12917 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
12918 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
12919 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
12924 @node Running GuixSD in a VM
12925 @subsection Running GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
12927 @cindex virtual machine
12928 One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
12929 virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
12930 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
12931 which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
12934 To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
12935 and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
12936 you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
12937 platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
12938 of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
12941 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
12942 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
12943 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
12946 Here is what each of these options means:
12949 @item qemu-system-x86_64
12950 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
12954 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
12955 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
12958 @item -net nic,model=virtio
12959 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
12960 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
12961 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
12962 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
12965 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
12966 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
12970 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
12971 which may be insufficient for some operations.
12973 @item /tmp/qemu-image
12974 The file name of the qcow2 image.
12977 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invokation of
12978 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-net user} flag by default.
12979 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
12980 to your system definition and start the VM using
12981 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -net user}. An important caveat of using
12982 @command{-net user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
12983 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
12984 network connectivity, like for example @command{curl}.
12986 @subsubsection Connecting Through SSH
12990 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add a SSH server like @code{(dropbear-service)}
12991 or @code{(lsh-service)} to your VM. The @code{(lsh-service}) doesn't currently
12992 boot unsupervised. It requires you to type some characters to initialize the
12993 randomness generator. In addition you need to forward the SSH port, 22 by
12994 default, to the host. You can do this with
12997 `guix system vm config.scm` -net user,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
13000 To connect to the VM you can run
13003 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
13006 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
13007 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
13008 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
13009 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
13010 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
13012 @subsubsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
13014 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
13015 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
13016 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
13017 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
13019 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
13020 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
13023 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
13024 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
13025 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
13026 name=com.redhat.spice.0
13029 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
13031 @node Defining Services
13032 @subsection Defining Services
13034 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
13035 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
13036 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
13039 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
13040 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
13041 * Service Reference:: API reference.
13042 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
13045 @node Service Composition
13046 @subsubsection Service Composition
13050 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
13051 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
13052 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
13053 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
13054 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
13055 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
13056 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
13057 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
13058 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
13059 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
13060 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
13063 @cindex service extensions
13064 GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
13065 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the GuixSD
13066 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
13067 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
13068 Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
13069 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
13070 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
13071 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
13072 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
13073 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
13074 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
13076 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
13077 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
13078 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
13080 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
13082 @cindex system service
13083 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
13084 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
13085 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
13086 to learn about the other service types shown here.
13087 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
13088 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
13089 particular operating system definition.
13091 @cindex service types
13092 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
13093 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
13094 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
13095 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
13096 different parameters.
13098 The following section describes the programming interface for service
13099 types and services.
13101 @node Service Types and Services
13102 @subsubsection Service Types and Services
13104 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
13105 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
13106 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
13109 (define guix-service-type
13113 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
13114 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
13115 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
13119 It defines two things:
13123 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
13126 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
13127 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
13128 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
13130 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
13131 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
13134 In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
13137 @item shepherd-root-service-type
13138 The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
13139 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
13140 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
13141 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
13143 @item account-service-type
13144 This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
13145 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
13146 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
13149 @item activation-service-type
13150 Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
13151 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
13155 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
13158 (service guix-service-type
13159 (guix-configuration
13161 (use-substitutes? #f)))
13164 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
13165 the parameters of this specific service instance.
13166 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
13167 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
13169 @var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
13170 services but is not extensible itself.
13172 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
13174 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
13177 (define udev-service-type
13178 (service-type (name 'udev)
13180 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
13181 udev-shepherd-service)))
13183 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
13184 (extend (lambda (config rules)
13186 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
13187 (udev-configuration
13188 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
13189 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
13192 This is the service type for the
13193 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
13194 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
13195 extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
13199 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
13200 services of this type.
13202 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
13203 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
13206 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
13207 the composition of the extensions.
13209 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
13210 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
13211 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
13212 list of contributed rules.
13215 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
13216 @var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
13217 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
13219 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
13220 interface for services.
13222 @node Service Reference
13223 @subsubsection Service Reference
13225 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
13226 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
13227 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
13228 @code{(gnu services)} module.
13230 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
13231 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
13232 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
13233 this particular service instance.
13236 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
13237 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
13240 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
13241 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
13244 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
13245 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
13249 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
13253 (service nginx-service-type
13254 (nginx-configuration
13256 (log-directory log-directory)
13257 (run-directory run-directory)
13258 (file config-file))))
13263 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
13267 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
13268 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
13269 @var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
13270 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
13271 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
13272 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
13273 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
13276 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
13277 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
13279 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
13280 clauses. Each clause has the form:
13283 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
13286 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
13287 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
13288 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
13289 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
13292 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
13293 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
13294 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
13295 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
13296 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
13297 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
13299 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
13303 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
13304 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
13305 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
13306 @code{operating-system} declaration.
13308 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
13309 @cindex service type
13310 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
13315 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
13317 @item @code{extensions}
13318 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
13320 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
13321 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
13322 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
13325 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
13326 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
13327 extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
13328 the service instance.
13330 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
13331 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
13333 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
13334 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first argument
13335 and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
13339 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
13342 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
13344 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
13345 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
13346 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
13347 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
13350 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
13351 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
13354 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
13355 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
13356 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
13357 provides a shorthand for this.
13359 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
13360 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
13361 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
13362 service is an instance.
13364 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
13368 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
13369 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
13373 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
13374 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
13375 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
13376 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
13377 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
13378 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
13379 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
13381 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
13382 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
13383 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
13384 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
13387 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
13388 service types, some of which are listed below.
13390 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
13391 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
13392 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
13395 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
13396 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
13397 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
13400 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
13401 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
13402 passing it name/file tuples such as:
13405 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
13408 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
13409 pointing to the given file.
13412 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
13413 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
13414 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
13415 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
13418 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
13419 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
13420 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
13421 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
13425 @node Shepherd Services
13426 @subsubsection Shepherd Services
13428 @cindex shepherd services
13430 @cindex init system
13431 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
13432 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the GuixSD
13433 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
13434 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
13435 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
13437 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
13438 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
13439 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
13440 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
13441 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
13443 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
13445 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
13446 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
13447 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
13449 The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
13450 PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
13451 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
13453 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
13454 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
13457 @item @code{provision}
13458 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
13460 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
13461 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
13462 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
13463 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
13465 @item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
13466 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
13468 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
13469 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
13470 underlying process dies.
13473 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
13474 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
13475 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
13476 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
13477 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
13478 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
13480 @item @code{documentation}
13481 A documentation string, as shown when running:
13484 herd doc @var{service-name}
13487 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
13488 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
13490 @item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
13491 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
13492 @code{stop} are evaluated.
13497 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
13498 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
13500 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
13501 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
13502 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
13505 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
13506 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
13510 @node Installing Debugging Files
13511 @section Installing Debugging Files
13513 @cindex debugging files
13514 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
13515 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
13516 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
13517 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
13518 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
13520 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
13521 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
13522 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
13523 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
13524 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
13525 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
13526 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
13528 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
13529 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
13530 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
13531 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
13532 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
13535 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
13536 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
13537 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
13538 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
13539 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
13540 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
13544 guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
13547 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
13548 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
13549 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
13553 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
13556 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
13557 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
13559 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
13560 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
13561 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
13562 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
13563 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
13564 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
13566 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
13567 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
13568 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
13569 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
13570 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
13571 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
13572 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
13573 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
13576 @node Security Updates
13577 @section Security Updates
13579 @cindex security updates
13580 @cindex security vulnerabilities
13581 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
13582 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
13583 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
13584 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
13585 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
13586 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
13591 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc-2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
13592 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc-4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
13593 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg-2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
13597 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
13600 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
13604 Guix follows a functional
13605 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
13606 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
13607 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
13608 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
13609 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
13610 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
13614 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
13615 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
13616 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
13617 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
13618 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
13619 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
13620 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
13622 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
13623 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
13624 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
13625 Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
13626 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
13627 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
13634 (replacement bash-fixed)))
13637 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
13638 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
13639 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
13640 @var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
13641 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
13642 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
13643 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
13644 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
13646 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
13647 the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and @var{bash} in the example
13648 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
13649 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
13650 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
13651 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
13652 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
13654 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
13655 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
13659 guix build bash --no-grafts
13663 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
13670 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
13671 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
13673 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
13674 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
13677 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
13681 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
13682 Likewise for a complete GuixSD system generation:
13685 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
13688 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
13689 @command{lsof} command:
13692 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
13696 @node Package Modules
13697 @section Package Modules
13699 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
13700 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
13701 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
13702 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
13703 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
13704 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
13705 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
13706 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
13707 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
13708 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
13709 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
13711 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
13712 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
13713 instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
13714 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
13715 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
13716 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
13718 @cindex customization, of packages
13719 @cindex package module search path
13720 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
13721 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
13722 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
13723 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
13724 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
13725 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
13726 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
13727 will not be visible by default. Users can invoke commands such as
13728 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} with the
13729 @code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
13730 yet, they can use the
13731 @code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
13732 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
13733 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
13734 variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
13735 honored by all the user interfaces.
13737 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
13738 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
13739 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
13740 over the own modules of the distribution.
13743 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
13744 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
13745 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
13746 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
13747 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
13748 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
13750 @node Packaging Guidelines
13751 @section Packaging Guidelines
13753 @cindex packages, creating
13754 The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
13755 packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
13756 grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
13759 Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
13760 @dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
13761 all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
13762 essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
13763 build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
13764 it, and adding @dfn{package metadata} along with that recipe, such as a
13765 description and licensing information.
13767 In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
13768 Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
13769 written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
13770 for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
13771 and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
13772 However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
13773 creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
13774 @pxref{Defining Packages}.
13776 Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
13777 source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
13778 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
13779 called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
13780 (@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
13783 ./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
13786 Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
13787 it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
13788 command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
13791 If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
13792 the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
13793 clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
13794 the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
13797 ./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
13800 Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
13801 (@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
13802 help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
13803 new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
13804 @url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
13807 @cindex substituter
13808 Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
13809 @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
13810 @code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
13811 package automatically downloads binaries from there
13812 (@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
13813 needed is to review and apply the patch.
13817 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
13818 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
13819 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
13820 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
13821 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
13822 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
13823 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
13824 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
13827 @node Software Freedom
13828 @subsection Software Freedom
13830 @c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
13831 @cindex free software
13832 The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
13833 freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
13834 users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
13835 essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
13836 in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
13837 modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
13838 software that conveys these four freedoms.
13840 In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
13841 @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
13842 software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
13843 reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
13844 discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
13846 Some otherwise free upstream package sources contain a small and optional
13847 subset that violates the above guidelines, for instance because this subset
13848 is itself non-free code. When that happens, the offending items are removed
13849 with appropriate patches or code snippets in the @code{origin} form of the
13850 package (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This way, @code{guix
13851 build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
13855 @node Package Naming
13856 @subsection Package Naming
13858 @cindex package name
13859 A package has actually two names associated with it:
13860 First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
13861 @code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
13862 Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
13863 the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
13864 is used by package management commands such as
13865 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
13867 Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
13868 the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
13869 hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
13870 SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
13872 We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
13873 already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
13874 Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
13875 the Python and Perl languages.
13877 Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
13880 @node Version Numbers
13881 @subsection Version Numbers
13883 @cindex package version
13884 We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
13885 project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
13886 two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
13887 different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
13888 in @ref{Package Naming}
13889 for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
13890 by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
13891 distinguish the two versions.
13893 The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
13894 package and does not contain any version number.
13896 For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
13899 (define-public gtk+
13904 (define-public gtk+-2
13907 (version "2.24.20")
13910 If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
13912 (define-public gtk+-3.8
13919 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
13920 @c for a discussion of what follows.
13921 @cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
13922 Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
13923 (VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
13924 because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
13925 release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
13926 the @code{version} field?
13928 Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
13929 visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
13930 version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
13931 --upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
13932 identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
13933 a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
13934 snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
13939 | | `-- upstream commit ID
13941 | `--- Guix package revision
13943 latest upstream version
13946 It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
13947 field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
13948 aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
13949 limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
13950 kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
13951 @code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities. A typical package
13952 definition may look like this:
13956 (let ((commit "c3f29bc928d5900971f65965feaae59e1272a3f7")
13957 (revision "1")) ;Guix package revision
13959 (version (string-append "0.9-" revision "."
13960 (string-take commit 7)))
13963 (uri (git-reference
13964 (url "git://example.org/my-package.git")
13966 (sha256 (base32 "1mbikn@dots{}"))
13967 (file-name (string-append "my-package-" version
13973 @node Synopses and Descriptions
13974 @subsection Synopses and Descriptions
13976 @cindex package description
13977 @cindex package synopsis
13978 As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
13979 synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
13980 descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
13981 --search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
13982 determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
13983 packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
13985 Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
13986 period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
13987 not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
13988 tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
13989 is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
13990 used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
13991 matching a pattern''.
13993 Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
13994 audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
13995 might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
13996 fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
13997 is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
13998 application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
13999 something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
14000 hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
14003 Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
14004 sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
14005 Please avoid marketing phrases such as ``world-leading'',
14006 ``industrial-strength'', and ``next-generation'', and avoid superlatives
14007 like ``the most advanced''---they are not helpful to users looking for a
14008 package and may even sound suspicious. Instead, try to be factual,
14009 mentioning use cases and features.
14011 @cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
14012 Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
14013 ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
14014 hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
14015 should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
14016 curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
14017 (@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
14018 such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
14021 Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
14022 @uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
14023 Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
14024 their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
14025 the language specified by the current locale.
14027 Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
14028 attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
14029 additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
14030 to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
14031 special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
14035 ;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
14036 (description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
14037 for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
14041 @node Python Modules
14042 @subsection Python Modules
14045 We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
14046 @code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
14047 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
14048 seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
14049 the word @code{python}.
14051 Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
14052 If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
14053 @code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
14054 @code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
14055 packages with the corresponding names.
14057 If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
14058 for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
14059 @code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}. If the project name
14060 starts with @code{py} (e.g. @code{pytz}), we keep it and prefix it as
14063 @subsubsection Specifying Dependencies
14064 @cindex inputs, for Python packages
14066 Dependency information for Python packages is usually available in the
14067 package source tree, with varying degrees of accuracy: in the
14068 @file{setup.py} file, in @file{requirements.txt}, or in @file{tox.ini}.
14070 Your mission, when writing a recipe for a Python package, is to map
14071 these dependencies to the appropriate type of ``input'' (@pxref{package
14072 Reference, inputs}). Although the @code{pypi} importer normally does a
14073 good job (@pxref{Invoking guix import}), you may want to check the
14074 following check list to determine which dependency goes where.
14079 We currently package Python 2 with @code{setuptools} and @code{pip}
14080 installed like Python 3.4 has per default. Thus you don't need to
14081 specify either of these as an input. @command{guix lint} will warn you
14085 Python dependencies required at run time go into
14086 @code{propagated-inputs}. They are typically defined with the
14087 @code{install_requires} keyword in @file{setup.py}, or in the
14088 @file{requirements.txt} file.
14091 Python packages required only at build time---e.g., those listed with
14092 the @code{setup_requires} keyword in @file{setup.py}---or only for
14093 testing---e.g., those in @code{tests_require}---go into
14094 @code{native-inputs}. The rationale is that (1) they do not need to be
14095 propagated because they are not needed at run time, and (2) in a
14096 cross-compilation context, it's the ``native'' input that we'd want.
14098 Examples are the @code{pytest}, @code{mock}, and @code{nose} test
14099 frameworks. Of course if any of these packages is also required at
14100 run-time, it needs to go to @code{propagated-inputs}.
14103 Anything that does not fall in the previous categories goes to
14104 @code{inputs}, for example programs or C libraries required for building
14105 Python packages containing C extensions.
14108 If a Python package has optional dependencies (@code{extras_require}),
14109 it is up to you to decide whether to add them or not, based on their
14110 usefulness/overhead ratio (@pxref{Submitting Patches, @command{guix
14117 @subsection Perl Modules
14120 Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
14121 using the lowercase upstream name.
14122 For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
14123 replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
14125 So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
14126 Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
14127 are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
14128 @code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
14129 prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
14132 @node Java Packages
14133 @subsection Java Packages
14136 Java programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
14137 using the lowercase upstream name.
14139 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages,
14140 it is desirable that the name of a package for a Java package is
14141 prefixed with @code{java-}. If a project already contains the word
14142 @code{java}, we drop this; for instance, the package @code{ngsjava} is
14143 packaged under the name @code{java-ngs}.
14145 For Java packages containing a single class or a small class hierarchy,
14146 we use the lowercase class name, replace all occurrences of @code{.} by
14147 dashes and prepend the prefix @code{java-}. So the class
14148 @code{apache.commons.cli} becomes package
14149 @code{java-apache-commons-cli}.
14156 For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
14157 purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
14158 we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
14159 applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
14160 are part of TeX Live.
14162 To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
14163 containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
14164 upstream package name.
14166 The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
14167 @code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
14168 if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
14169 replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
14171 For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
14172 @code{font-sil-gentium}.
14174 For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
14175 is used in the place of the font family name.
14176 For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
14177 Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
14178 These could be packaged separately under the names
14179 @code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
14180 under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
14181 @code{font-liberation}.
14183 In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
14184 are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
14185 is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
14186 @code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
14191 @node Bootstrapping
14192 @section Bootstrapping
14194 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
14196 @cindex bootstrapping
14198 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
14199 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
14200 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
14201 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
14202 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
14203 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
14204 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
14205 a ``regular user''.
14207 @cindex bootstrap binaries
14208 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
14209 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
14210 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
14211 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
14212 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
14213 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
14214 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
14215 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
14216 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
14218 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
14219 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
14221 @unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
14223 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
14224 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
14225 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
14227 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
14228 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
14229 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
14230 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
14233 guix graph -t derivation \
14234 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
14238 At this level of detail, things are
14239 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
14240 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
14241 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
14242 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
14243 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
14244 (@pxref{The Store}).
14246 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
14247 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
14248 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
14249 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
14250 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
14251 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
14252 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
14253 tarball to be unpacked.
14255 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
14256 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
14257 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
14258 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
14259 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
14260 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
14261 in the store, using the original layout. The
14262 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
14263 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
14264 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
14265 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
14267 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
14268 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
14269 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
14272 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
14274 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
14275 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
14276 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
14277 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
14278 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
14279 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
14280 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
14282 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
14283 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
14284 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
14285 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
14286 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
14287 package from source. The command:
14290 guix graph -t bag \
14291 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
14292 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
14296 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
14297 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
14298 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
14299 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
14301 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
14303 @c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
14304 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
14305 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
14306 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
14309 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
14310 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
14311 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
14312 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
14314 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
14316 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
14317 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
14318 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
14320 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
14321 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
14322 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
14323 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
14324 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
14327 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
14329 @cindex bootstrap binaries
14330 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
14331 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
14332 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
14333 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
14335 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
14336 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
14337 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
14340 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
14343 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
14344 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
14347 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
14348 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
14349 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
14350 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
14354 @section Porting to a New Platform
14356 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
14357 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
14358 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
14359 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
14360 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
14361 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
14362 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
14364 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
14365 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
14366 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
14370 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
14373 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
14374 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
14375 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
14376 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
14377 taught about the new platform.
14379 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
14380 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
14381 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
14382 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
14383 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
14384 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules do download it for
14385 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
14388 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
14389 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
14390 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
14391 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
14392 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
14393 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
14394 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
14397 @c *********************************************************************
14398 @include contributing.texi
14400 @c *********************************************************************
14401 @node Acknowledgments
14402 @chapter Acknowledgments
14404 Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
14405 which was designed and
14406 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
14407 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
14408 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
14409 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
14410 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
14412 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
14413 an inspiration for Guix.
14415 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
14416 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
14417 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
14418 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
14419 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
14422 @c *********************************************************************
14423 @node GNU Free Documentation License
14424 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
14425 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
14426 @include fdl-1.3.texi
14428 @c *********************************************************************
14429 @node Concept Index
14430 @unnumbered Concept Index
14433 @node Programming Index
14434 @unnumbered Programming Index
14435 @syncodeindex tp fn
14436 @syncodeindex vr fn
14441 @c Local Variables:
14442 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";